Add -defer-examine option to target create command
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534 @end itemize
535
536 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
537
538 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
539 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
540 these on the market.
541
542 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
543 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
544 of USB-based ones.
545
546 @itemize @bullet
547
548 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
549 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
550
551 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
552 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
553 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
554
555 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
556 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
557
558 @item @b{Wiggler2}
559 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
560
561 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
562 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
563
564 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
565 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
566
567 @item @b{arm-jtag}
568 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
569
570 @item @b{chameleon}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Triton}
574 @* Unknown.
575
576 @item @b{Lattice}
577 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
578 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
579
580 @item @b{flashlink}
581 @* From ST Microsystems;
582 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
583
584 @end itemize
585
586 @section Other...
587 @itemize @bullet
588
589 @item @b{ep93xx}
590 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
591
592 @item @b{at91rm9200}
593 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
594
595 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
596 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
597
598 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
599 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
600 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
601
602 @end itemize
603
604 @node About Jim-Tcl
605 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
606 @cindex Jim-Tcl
607 @cindex tcl
608
609 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
610 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
611 command interpreter.
612
613 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
614 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
615 much of anything about Tcl.
616 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
617
618 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
619 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
620 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
621 OpenOCD mailing list.
622
623 @itemize @bullet
624 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
625 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
626 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
627 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
628 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
629 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
630
631 @item @b{Missing Features}
632 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
633 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
634 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
635 enabled in OpenOCD.
636
637 @item @b{Scripts}
638 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
639 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
640 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
641
642 @item @b{Commands}
643 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
644 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
645 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
646 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
647
648 @item @b{Historical Note}
649 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
650 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
651 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
652 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
653
654 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
655 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
656 @end itemize
657
658 @node Running
659 @chapter Running
660 @cindex command line options
661 @cindex logfile
662 @cindex directory search
663
664 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
665 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
666 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
667 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
668 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
669 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
670 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
671
672 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
673 tell it how each debug session should work.
674 The @option{--help} option shows:
675 @verbatim
676 bash$ openocd --help
677
678 --help | -h display this help
679 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
680 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
681 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
682 --debug | -d set debug level <0-3>
683 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
684 --command | -c run <command>
685 @end verbatim
686
687 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
688 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
689 To specify one or more different
690 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
691
692 @example
693 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
694 @end example
695
696 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
697 @enumerate
698 @item the current directory,
699 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
700 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
701 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
702 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
703 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
704 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
705 @end enumerate
706 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
707
708 @quotation Note
709 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
710 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
711 @end quotation
712
713 @section Simple setup, no customization
714
715 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
716 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
717 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
718 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
719 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
720
721 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
722 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
723 the server with some variation of one of the following:
724
725 @example
726 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
727 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
728 @end example
729
730 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
731 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
732 If all goes well you'll see output something like
733
734 @example
735 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
736 For bug reports, read
737 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
738 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
739 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
740 @end example
741
742 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
743 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
744 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
745
746 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
747
748 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
749 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
750 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
751 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
752 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
753 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
754 ensure that this always succeeds.
755 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
756 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
757 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
758 and then shut down without acting as a server.
759
760 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
761 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
762 those channels.
763
764 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
765 the @option{-d} option.
766
767 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
768 @option{-c} command line switch.
769
770 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
771 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
772 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
773 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
774 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
775 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
776 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
777
778 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
779 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
780
781 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
782 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
783 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
784 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
785
786 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
787 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
788
789 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
790 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
791 and start the OpenOCD server.
792 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
793 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
794 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
795 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
796
797 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
798
799 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
800 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
801 and a USB cable on the other.
802 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
803 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
804
805 @enumerate
806 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
807 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
808 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
809 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
810 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
811 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
812 debugging host.
813
814 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
815 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
816 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
817 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
818 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
819
820 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
821 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
822 with 1.2 Volt boards.
823
824 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
825 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
826 ways to connect the cable.
827 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
828 Be sure it's firmly connected.
829
830 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
831 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
832 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
833 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
834 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
835 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
836 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
837 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
838
839 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
840 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
841 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
842 but are tedious to set up.
843 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
844 adapter signals to the right board pins.
845
846 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
847 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
848 you are using to run OpenOCD.
849 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
850
851 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
852 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
853 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
854 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
855
856 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
857 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
858 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
859
860 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
861 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
862 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
863 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
864
865 @end enumerate
866
867 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
868 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
869 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
870
871 @section Project Directory
872
873 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
874
875 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
876 single directory for your work with a given board.
877 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
878 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
879 files accessed through semihosting,
880 and for code you upload to the target board.
881 It is also the natural place to write files,
882 such as log files and data you download from the board.
883
884 @section Configuration Basics
885
886 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
887 a variety of ways you can mix them.
888 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
889
890 @itemize
891 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
892 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
893 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
894 @end itemize
895
896 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
897 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
898 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
899
900 @example
901 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
902
903 # GDB can also flash my flash!
904 gdb_memory_map enable
905 gdb_flash_program enable
906
907 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
908 @end example
909
910 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
911
912 @example
913 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
914 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
915 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
916 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
917 @end example
918
919 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
920 each supporting a different development task.
921 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
922 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
923
924 @quotation Important
925 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
926 problems with how it treats variables.
927 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
928 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
929 that can be tested in a later script.
930 @end quotation
931
932 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
933 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
934 to simplify your work.
935
936 @section User Config Files
937 @cindex config file, user
938 @cindex user config file
939 @cindex config file, overview
940
941 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
942 in one place.
943 One of the following will match your situation best:
944
945 @itemize
946 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
947 provided by someone else.
948 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
949 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
950 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
951 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
952 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
953 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
954
955 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
956 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
957
958 @enumerate
959 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
960 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
961 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
962 @end enumerate
963
964 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
965 The first is an interface config file.
966 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
967 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
968 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
969 meet your deadline:
970
971 @example
972 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
973 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
974 @end example
975
976 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
977 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
978 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
979 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
980
981 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
982 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
983 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
984 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
985 target and board
986 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
987 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
988
989 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
990 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
991 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
992 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
993
994 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
995 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
996 giving access to your particular flash chips.
997 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
998 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
999
1000 @quotation Note
1001 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1002 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1003 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1004 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1005 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1006 @end quotation
1007
1008 @item
1009 You may may need to write some C code.
1010 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1011 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1012 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1013 a new chip architecture.
1014 @end itemize
1015
1016 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1017 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1018 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1019
1020 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1021 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1022 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1023 @itemize
1024
1025 @item
1026 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1027 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1028 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1029 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1030
1031 @item
1032 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1033 @cindex vector_catch
1034 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1035 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a timesaver
1036 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1037 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1038 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1039 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1040
1041 @item
1042 You might need to override some defaults.
1043 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1044 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1045
1046 @item
1047 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1048 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1049 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1050 @end itemize
1051
1052 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1053
1054 A few project-specific utility
1055 routines may well speed up your work.
1056 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1057
1058 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1059 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1060 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1061 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1062 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1063 may help:
1064
1065 @example
1066 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1067 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1068 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1069 # Leave the CPU halted.
1070 reset init
1071
1072 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1073 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1074
1075 # Start running.
1076 resume 0x20000000
1077 @}
1078 @end example
1079
1080 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1081 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1082 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1083 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1084 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1085
1086 @example
1087 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1088 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1089 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1090 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1091 reset init
1092
1093 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1094 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1095 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1096 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1097 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1098 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1099 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1100
1101 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1102 reset run
1103 @}
1104 @end example
1105
1106 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1107 from NAND.
1108 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1109 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1110 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1111
1112 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1113 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1114
1115 @section Target Software Changes
1116
1117 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1118 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1119 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1120 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1121 handling issues like:
1122
1123 @itemize @bullet
1124
1125 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1126 Watchog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1127 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1128 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1129 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1130 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1131 your debug sessions.
1132
1133 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1134 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1135 That might however be your only option.
1136
1137 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1138 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1139 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1140 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1141 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1142 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1143 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1144 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1145 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1146 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1147 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1148 instead of the whole thing.
1149 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1150 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1151
1152 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1153 @cindex ARM semihosting
1154 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1155 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1156 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1157 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1158 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1159 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1160 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1161 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1162 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1163 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1164 NAND or SPI flash.
1165
1166 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1167 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1168 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1169 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1170 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1171
1172 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1173 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1174 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1175 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1176 registers which can be used to change various features including
1177 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1178 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1179 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1180 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1181 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1182
1183 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1184 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1185 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1186 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1187 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1188
1189 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1190 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1191 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1192 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1193 early code execution can be debugged
1194 or firmware can be replaced.
1195
1196 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1197 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1198 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1199 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1200 operations like writing to memory.)
1201
1202 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1203 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1204 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1205 various kinds of message.
1206 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1207
1208 @end itemize
1209
1210 @section Target Hardware Setup
1211
1212 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1213 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1214 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1215 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1216 working with.}
1217
1218 Common issues include:
1219
1220 @itemize @bullet
1221
1222 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1223 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1224 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1225 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1226 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1227 or one from a daughtercard).
1228 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1229 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1230
1231 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1232 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1233 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1234 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1235 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1236 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1237
1238 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1239 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1240 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1241 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1242 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1243
1244
1245 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1246 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1247 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1248 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1249 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1250 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1251 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1252
1253 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1254 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1255 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1256 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1257 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1258
1259 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1260 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1261 used to start booting.
1262
1263 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1264 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1265 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1266 multiple audio codec chips).
1267 This interacts with software
1268 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1269 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1270 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1271 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1272 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1273 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1274 audio or video codecs are used.
1275
1276 @end itemize
1277
1278 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1279 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1280 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1281 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1282 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1283 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1284 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1285 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1286 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1287 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1288
1289
1290 @node Config File Guidelines
1291 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1292
1293 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1294 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1295 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1296 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1297
1298 You should find the following directories under
1299 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1300 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1301 @itemize @bullet
1302 @item @file{interface} ...
1303 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1304 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1305 @item @file{board} ...
1306 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1307 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1308
1309 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1310 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1311 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1312 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1313 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1314 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1315 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1316 a CPU and an FPGA.
1317 @item @file{target} ...
1318 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1319 on a chip
1320 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1321 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1322 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1323 the target config file defines all of them.
1324 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1325 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1326 @end itemize
1327
1328 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1329 file may override features in any of the above files by
1330 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1331 commands specific to their situation.
1332
1333 @section Interface Config Files
1334
1335 The user config file
1336 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1337
1338 @example
1339 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1340 @end example
1341
1342 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1343 in use today with OpenOCD.
1344 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1345 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1346
1347 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1348 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1349 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1350 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1351 and need to provide a driver for it.
1352
1353 @section Board Config Files
1354 @cindex config file, board
1355 @cindex board config file
1356
1357 The user config file
1358 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1359
1360 @example
1361 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1362 @end example
1363
1364 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1365 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1366 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1367
1368 @enumerate
1369 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1370 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1371 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1372 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1373 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1374 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1378 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1379 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1380 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1381
1382 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1383 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1384 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1385 configuration works.
1386
1387 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1388
1389 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1390 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1391 convention on how to use certain variables.
1392
1393 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1394 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1395 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1396 used at will within a target configuration file.
1397
1398 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1399 for a board with three chips:
1400
1401 @example
1402 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1403 set CHIPNAME network
1404 set ENDIAN big
1405 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1406 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1407 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1408 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1409
1410 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1411 set CHIPNAME video
1412 set ENDIAN little
1413 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1414 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1415 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1416 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1417
1418 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1419 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1420 unset ENDIAN
1421 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1422 @end example
1423
1424 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1425 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1426 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1427 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1428 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1429 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1430 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1431 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1432
1433 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1434 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1435 naming collisions.
1436
1437 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1438 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1439 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1440 up other clocks and peripherals.
1441
1442 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1443 @cindex variable names
1444
1445 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1446 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1447 one such chip (as shown above).
1448 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1449 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1450 to promote consistency and
1451 so that board files can override target defaults.
1452
1453 Inputs to target config files include:
1454
1455 @itemize @bullet
1456 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1457 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1458 tap identifier dotted names.
1459 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1460 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1461 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1462 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1463 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1464 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1465 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1466 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1467 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1468 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1469 @end itemize
1470
1471 Outputs from target config files include:
1472
1473 @itemize @bullet
1474 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1475 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1476 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1477 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1478 specific to that board and that target.
1479 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1480 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1481 @end itemize
1482
1483 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1484 @cindex event, reset-init
1485 @cindex reset-init handler
1486
1487 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1488 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1489 fully set up yet.
1490 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1491 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1492 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1493 handler is one of the most important.
1494
1495 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1496 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1497 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1498 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1499 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1500
1501 @quotation Note
1502 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1503 are included here.
1504 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1505 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1506 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1507 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1508 @end quotation
1509
1510 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1511 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1512 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1513 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1514 those as parameters.
1515 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1516 and disabling the watchdog.
1517 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1518 the next developer doing such work.
1519 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1520
1521 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1522 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1523 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1524 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1525
1526 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1527
1528 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1529 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1530 a low JTAG clock rate.
1531 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1532 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1533 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1534 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1535 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1536 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1537 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1538
1539 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1540 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1541 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1542 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1543 which might be less than that.
1544
1545 @quotation Warning
1546 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1547 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1548 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1549 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1550 @end quotation
1551
1552 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1553 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1554 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1555 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1556 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1557 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1558
1559 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1560 @subsection The init_board procedure
1561 @cindex init_board procedure
1562
1563 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1564 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1565 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1566 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1567 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1568 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1569 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1570 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1571 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1572 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1573 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1574 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1575
1576 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1577 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1578
1579 @example
1580 ### board_file.cfg ###
1581
1582 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1583 source [find target/target.cfg]
1584
1585 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1586 # enables fast on-board clock source
1587 # configures the chip to use it
1588 @}
1589
1590 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1591 proc init_board @{@} @{
1592 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1593
1594 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1595 adapter_khz 1
1596 enable_fast_clock
1597 adapter_khz 10000
1598 @}
1599 @}
1600 @end example
1601
1602 @section Target Config Files
1603 @cindex config file, target
1604 @cindex target config file
1605
1606 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1607 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1608 more target config files like this:
1609
1610 @example
1611 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1612 @end example
1613
1614 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1615 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1616 In summary the target files should contain
1617
1618 @enumerate
1619 @item Set defaults
1620 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1621 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1622 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1623 @item On-Chip flash
1624 @end enumerate
1625
1626 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1627 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1628 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1629
1630 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1631 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1632 can talk to the chip.
1633 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1634 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1635 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1636 and other processing engines.
1637
1638 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1639
1640 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1641 letting board config files express environment-specific
1642 differences in how things should be set up.
1643
1644 @example
1645 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1646 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1647 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1648 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1649 @} else @{
1650 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1651 @}
1652
1653 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1654 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1655 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1656 @} else @{
1657 set _ENDIAN little
1658 @}
1659
1660 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1661 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1662 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1663 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1664 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1665 @} else @{
1666 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1667 @}
1668 @end example
1669 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1670
1671 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1672 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1673 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1674
1675 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1676 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1677 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1678
1679 @example
1680 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1681 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1682 @end example
1683
1684 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1685 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1686 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1687 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1688 for taps.
1689
1690 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1691 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1692 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1693 looks (in part) like this:
1694
1695 @example
1696 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1697 @end example
1698
1699 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1700 to source such a config file twice, with different
1701 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1702 it adds a different TAP each time.
1703
1704 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1705 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1706 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1707 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1708
1709 @example
1710 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1711 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1712 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1713 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1714 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1715 @end example
1716
1717 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1718 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1719
1720 @itemize
1721 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1722 plus a JRC to enable them
1723 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1724 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1725 is not currently used)
1726 @end itemize
1727
1728 @subsection Add CPU targets
1729
1730 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1731 GDB and other commands can use it.
1732 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1733 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1734 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1735 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1736
1737 @example
1738 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1739 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1740 @end example
1741
1742 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1743 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1744 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1745 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1746 a work area if you can.
1747 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1748
1749 @example
1750 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1751 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1752 @end example
1753
1754 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1755 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1756 @cindex SMP
1757 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1761 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1762 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1763 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1764 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1765 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1766 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1767 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1768 @end example
1769 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1770 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1771 @itemize @bullet
1772 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1773 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1774 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1775 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1776 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1777 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1778 @end itemize
1779
1780 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1781 command have been implemented.
1782 @itemize @bullet
1783 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1784 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1785 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1786 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1787 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1788 following example.
1789 @end itemize
1790
1791 @example
1792 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1793 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1794 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1795 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1796 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1797 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1798 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1799 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1800 > resume
1801 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1802 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1803 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1804 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1805 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1806 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1807 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1808 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 @end example
1810
1811
1812 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1813
1814 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1815 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1816 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1817
1818 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1819 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1820 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1821 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1822 both signals.
1823
1824 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1825 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1826 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1827 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1828 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1829 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1830 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1831 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1832 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1833 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1834 not available.)
1835
1836 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1837 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1838 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1839 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1840 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1841 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1842 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1843 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1844
1845 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1846 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1847 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1848 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1849 slower clock than they will use later.
1850 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1851 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1852 than they will use later.
1853 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1854
1855 @quotation Important
1856 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1857 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1858 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1859 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1860 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1861 @end quotation
1862
1863 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1864 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1865 @cindex init_targets procedure
1866
1867 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1868 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1869 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1870 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1871 Such procedure can be overriden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1872 This concept faciliates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1873 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enchanced or changed in
1874 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1875 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1876
1877 @example
1878 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1879
1880 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1881 # basic initialization procedure ...
1882 @}
1883
1884 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1885 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1886 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1887 @}
1888
1889 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1890
1891 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1892
1893 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1894 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1895 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1896 @}
1897 @end example
1898
1899 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1900 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1901
1902 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1903
1904 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1905 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1906
1907 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1908 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1909 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1910
1911 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1912 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1913 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1914 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1915 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1916 events already assigned.
1917
1918 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1919
1920 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1921 special high speed download features - enable it.
1922
1923 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1924
1925 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1926 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1927 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1928 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1929 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1930 If you are using an external trace port,
1931 configure it in your board config file.
1932 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1933 configure it in your target config file.
1934
1935 @example
1936 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1937 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1938 @end example
1939
1940 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1941
1942 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1943
1944 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1945 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1946 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1947 the TARGET (chip) file.
1948
1949 Examples:
1950 @itemize @bullet
1951 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1952 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1953 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1954 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1955 @end itemize
1956
1957 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1958 @section Translating Configuration Files
1959 @cindex translation
1960 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1961 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1962 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1963 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1964 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1965 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1966
1967 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1968 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1969 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1970 convert other scripts later on.
1971
1972 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1973 replace job:
1974
1975 @example
1976 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1977 #
1978 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1979 #
1980 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1981 #
1982 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1983
1984 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1985 global TARGETNAME
1986
1987 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
1988
1989 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
1990 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
1991 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
1992 @}
1993 @end example
1994
1995
1996
1997 @node Server Configuration
1998 @chapter Server Configuration
1999 @cindex initialization
2000 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2001 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2002 supported.
2003
2004 @anchor{configurationstage}
2005 @section Configuration Stage
2006 @cindex configuration stage
2007 @cindex config command
2008
2009 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2010 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2011 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2012 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2013 inside startup scripts.
2014
2015 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2016 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2017 which may be issued interactively.
2018 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2019 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2020
2021 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2022 flash banks,
2023 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2024 and other basic setup.
2025 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2026 may access or activate TAPs.
2027 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2028 longer be issued.
2029
2030 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2031 @section Entering the Run Stage
2032
2033 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2034 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2035 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2036 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2037 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2038 You should see no errors at this point.
2039 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2040 commands you used to configure the server.
2041 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2042 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2043 on the scan chain.
2044
2045 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2046 become available.
2047 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2048 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2049 a target has been successfuly instantiated.
2050 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2051 entry to the run stage.
2052
2053 @deffn {Config Command} init
2054 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2055 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2056 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2057 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2058 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2059 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2060
2061 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2062 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2063 configuration files and/or command line options.
2064
2065 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2066 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2067 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2068 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2069 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2070 @end deffn
2071
2072 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2073 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2074 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075
2076 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2077 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2078 scan chain.
2079 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2080 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2081
2082 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2083 they return.
2084 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2085 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2086 @end deffn
2087
2088 @anchor{tcpipports}
2089 @section TCP/IP Ports
2090 @cindex TCP port
2091 @cindex server
2092 @cindex port
2093 @cindex security
2094 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2095 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2096 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2097
2098 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2099 access using one or more of these ports.
2100 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2101 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2102 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2103
2104 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2105 @cindex GDB server
2106 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2107 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2108 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2109 the normal use cases.
2110
2111 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2112 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2113 disables the gdb server.
2114
2115 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2116 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2117
2118 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2119 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2120
2121 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2122 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2123 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2124
2125 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2126 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2127 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2128 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2129
2130 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2131 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2132 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2133
2134 @end deffn
2135
2136 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2137 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2138 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2139 output from the Tcl engine.
2140 Intended as a machine interface.
2141 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2142 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2143 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2144 @end deffn
2145
2146 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2147 Specify or query the
2148 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2149 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2150 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2151 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2152 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2153 @end deffn
2154
2155 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2156 @section GDB Configuration
2157 @cindex GDB
2158 @cindex GDB configuration
2159 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2160 The ones listed here are static and global.
2161 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2162 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2163
2164 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2165 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2166 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2167 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2168 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2169 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2170 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2174 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2175 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2176 vFlash packet is received.
2177 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2178 @end deffn
2179
2180 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2181 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2182 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2183 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2184 for flash programming to work.
2185 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2186 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2187 @end deffn
2188
2189 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2191 by GDB memory read packets.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2193 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2197 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2198 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2202 Saves the target descripton file to the local file system.
2203
2204 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2205 @end deffn
2206
2207 @anchor{eventpolling}
2208 @section Event Polling
2209
2210 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2211 where significant events can happen at any time.
2212 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2213 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2214 or to GDB.
2215
2216 Examples of such events include:
2217
2218 @itemize
2219 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2220 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2221 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2222 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2223 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2224 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2225 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2226 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2227 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2228 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2229 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2230 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2231 @end itemize
2232
2233 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2234 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2235 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2236 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2237 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2238
2239 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2240 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2241 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2242 to the various active targets.
2243 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2244 which is normally done in the background.
2245
2246 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2247 Poll the current target for its current state.
2248 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2249 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2250 specific information about the current state is printed.
2251 An optional parameter
2252 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2253
2254 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2255 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2256 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2257 @example
2258 > poll
2259 background polling: on
2260 target state: halted
2261 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2262 current mode: Supervisor
2263 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2264 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2265 >
2266 @end example
2267 @end deffn
2268
2269 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2270 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2271 @cindex config file, interface
2272 @cindex interface config file
2273
2274 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2275 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2276 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2277
2278 @quotation Note
2279 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2280 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2281 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2282 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2283 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2284 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2285 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2286 @end quotation
2287
2288 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2289 through commands in an interface configuration
2290 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2291 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2292
2293 @example
2294 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2295 @end example
2296
2297 These commands tell
2298 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2299 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2300
2301 @example
2302 # jlink interface
2303 interface jlink
2304 @end example
2305
2306 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2307
2308
2309 @section Interface Configuration
2310
2311 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2312 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2313 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2314
2315 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2316 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2317 target.
2318 @end deffn
2319
2320 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2321 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2322 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2323 @end deffn
2324 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2325 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2326 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2327 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2328 the hardware can support.
2329 @end deffn
2330
2331
2332
2333 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2334 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2335 @end deffn
2336
2337 @section Interface Drivers
2338
2339 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2340 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2341 available at run time.
2342
2343 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2344 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2345 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2346 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2347
2348 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2349 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2350 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2354 Displays status of RTCK option.
2355 Optionally sets that option first.
2356 @end deffn
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2360 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2361 This has one driver-specific command:
2362
2363 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2364 Logs some status
2365 @end deffn
2366 @end deffn
2367
2368 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2369 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2370 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2371 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2372 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2373 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2374 @end deffn
2375
2376 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2377 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2378
2379 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2380 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2381 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2382 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2383 @example
2384 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2385 @end example
2386 @end deffn
2387
2388 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2389 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2390 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2394 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2395 @end deffn
2396 @end deffn
2397
2398 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2399 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2400 @end deffn
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2403 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2404 @end deffn
2405
2406 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2407 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2408 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2409
2410 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2411 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi of D2XX.
2412
2413 A major improvement of this driver is that support for new FTDI based adapters
2414 can be added competely through configuration files, without the need to patch
2415 and rebuild OpenOCD.
2416
2417 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2418 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2419 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2420 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2421 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2422 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2423
2424 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2425 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2426 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2427 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2428
2429 @itemize @minus
2430 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2431 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2432 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2433 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2434 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2435 switching data and direction as necessary
2436 @end itemize
2437
2438 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2439 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2440
2441 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2442 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, the FTDI
2443 default values are used.
2444 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2445 @example
2446 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2447 @end example
2448 @end deffn
2449
2450 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2451 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2452 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2453 during device selection.
2454 @end deffn
2455
2456 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2457 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2458 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2459 is connected to the host.
2460 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2461 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2462 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2463 @end deffn
2464
2465 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2466 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2467 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2468 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2469 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2470 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2471
2472 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2473 @end deffn
2474
2475 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2476 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2477 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2478 @end deffn
2479
2480 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2481 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2482 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2483 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2484 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2485 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2486 and initially asserted reset signals.
2487 @end deffn
2488
2489 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2490 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2491 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2492 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2493 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2494 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2495 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2496 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2497 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2498 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2499 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2500
2501 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2502 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2503 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2504 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2505 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2506 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2507
2508 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2509 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2510 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2511 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2512 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2513 are always driven by the FTDI.
2514
2515 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2516 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2517 @var{name}.
2518 @end deffn
2519
2520 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2521 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2522 @itemize @minus
2523 @item @option{0}, drive low
2524 @item @option{1}, drive high
2525 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2526 @end itemize
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2530 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2531 @end deffn
2532
2533 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2534 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2535
2536 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2537 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possiblity to sample
2538 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2539 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2540 @itemize @minus
2541 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2542 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2543 @end itemize
2544 @end deffn
2545
2546 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2547 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2548
2549 @end deffn
2550
2551 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2552 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2553 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2554 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2555
2556 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2557 processors which are being simulated.
2558
2559 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2560 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2561 sockets instead of TCP.
2562 @end deffn
2563
2564 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2565 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2566 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2567 @end deffn
2568
2569 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2570 something like:
2571
2572 @example
2573 interface remote_bitbang
2574 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2575 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2576 @end example
2577
2578 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2579 named mysocket:
2580
2581 @example
2582 interface remote_bitbang
2583 remote_bitbang_port 0
2584 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2585 @end example
2586 @end deffn
2587
2588 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2589 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2590 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2591 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2592
2593 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2594 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2595 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2596 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2597 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2598 @end deffn
2599
2600 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2601 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2602 default values are used.
2603 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2604 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2605 @example
2606 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2607 @end example
2608 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2609 @example
2610 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2611 @end example
2612 @end deffn
2613
2614 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2615 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2616 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2617 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2618 target board.
2619
2620 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2621 @example
2622 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2623 reset_config srst_only
2624 @end example
2625 @end deffn
2626
2627 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2628 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2629 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2630 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2631 @end deffn
2632
2633 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2634 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2635 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2636 @end deffn
2637
2638 @end deffn
2639
2640 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2641 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2642 This has one driver-specific command:
2643
2644 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2645 Display either the address of the I/O port
2646 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2647 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2648 This is a write-once setting.
2649 @end deffn
2650 @end deffn
2651
2652 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2653 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2654 transports.
2655
2656 @quotation Compatibility Note
2657 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many harware versions they
2658 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2659 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2660 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2661 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2662 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2663 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2664 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2665 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2666 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2667 @end quotation
2668
2669 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2670 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2671 states.
2672 @end deffn
2673 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2674 Display free device internal memory.
2675 @end deffn
2676 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2677 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2678 command version.
2679 @end deffn
2680 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2681 Display the device configuration.
2682 @end deffn
2683 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2684 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2685 power state.
2686 @end deffn
2687 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2688 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2689 @end deffn
2690 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2691 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2692 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2693 IP configuration.
2694 @end deffn
2695 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2696 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2697 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2698 @end deffn
2699 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2700 Reset the current configuration.
2701 @end deffn
2702 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2703 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2704 @end deffn
2705 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2706 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2707 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2708 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2709 instead.
2710
2711 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2712 @end deffn
2713 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2714 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2715 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2716
2717 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2718 @end deffn
2719 @end deffn
2720
2721 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2722 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2723 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2724 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2725 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2726
2727 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2728 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2729 This is a write-once setting.
2730 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2731
2732 @itemize @minus
2733 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2734 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2735 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2736 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2737 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2738 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2739 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2740 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2741 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2742 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2743 some versions of
2744 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2745 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2746 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2747 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2748 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2749 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2750 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2751 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2752 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2753 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2754 @end itemize
2755 @end deffn
2756
2757 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2758 Display either the address of the I/O port
2759 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2760 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2761 This is a write-once setting.
2762
2763 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2764 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2765 you may encounter a problem.
2766 @end deffn
2767
2768 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2769 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2770 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2771 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2772 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2773 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2774
2775 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2776 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2777 @quotation Tip
2778 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2779 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2780 @example
2781 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2782 > adapter_khz 500
2783 @end example
2784 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2785 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2786 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2787 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2788 large set of samples.
2789 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2790 @example
2791 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2792 @end example
2793 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2794 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2795
2796 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2797 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2798 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2799 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2800 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2801 @end quotation
2802 @end deffn
2803
2804 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2805 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2806 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2807 @end deffn
2808
2809 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2810 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2811
2812 @example
2813 interface parport
2814 parport_port 0x278
2815 parport_cable wiggler
2816 @end example
2817 @end deffn
2818
2819 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2820 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2821 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2822 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2823 @end deffn
2824 @end deffn
2825
2826 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2827 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2828 @end deffn
2829
2830 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2831 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2832 @end deffn
2833
2834 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2835 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2836
2837 @quotation Note
2838 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2839 which are not currently documented here.
2840 @end quotation
2841 @end deffn
2842
2843 @anchor{hla_interface}
2844 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2845 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2846 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2847 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2848
2849 Currently supported adapters include the ST STLINK and TI ICDI.
2850 STLINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2851 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2852 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade STLINK firmware even if current
2853 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2854
2855 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2856 Currently Not Supported.
2857 @end deffn
2858
2859 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2860 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2861 @end deffn
2862
2863 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2864 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
2865 @end deffn
2866
2867 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} vid pid
2868 The vendor ID and product ID of the device.
2869 @end deffn
2870
2871 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
2872 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
2873 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
2874 @end deffn
2875 @end deffn
2876
2877 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
2878 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2879 @end deffn
2880
2881 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
2882 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
2883 @end deffn
2884
2885 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
2886 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
2887 @end deffn
2888
2889 @quotation Note
2890 This defines some driver-specific commands,
2891 which are not currently documented here.
2892 @end quotation
2893
2894 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2895 Turn power switch to target on/off.
2896 No arguments: print status.
2897 @end deffn
2898
2899 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
2900 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
2901 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
2902
2903 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
2904 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
2905 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
2906 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
2907 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
2908 configuration on exit.
2909
2910 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
2911 pinout.
2912
2913 @end deffn
2914
2915 @section Transport Configuration
2916 @cindex Transport
2917 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
2918 and the debug adapter you are using,
2919 several transports may be available to
2920 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
2921 @deffn Command {transport list}
2922 displays the names of the transports supported by this
2923 version of OpenOCD.
2924 @end deffn
2925
2926 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
2927 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
2928
2929 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
2930 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
2931 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
2932 adapter's driver).
2933
2934 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
2935 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
2936 supported by the debug adapter.
2937
2938 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
2939 transport, if any.
2940 @end deffn
2941
2942 @subsection JTAG Transport
2943 @cindex JTAG
2944 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
2945 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
2946 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
2947 each of which must be explicitly declared.
2948 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
2949 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
2950
2951 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
2952 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
2953 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
2954 hla_jtag}.
2955
2956 @subsection SWD Transport
2957 @cindex SWD
2958 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
2959 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
2960 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
2961 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
2962 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
2963 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
2964 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
2965
2966 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
2967 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
2968 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
2969 hla_swd}.
2970
2971 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
2972 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
2973 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
2974 expected to change.
2975 @end deffn
2976 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
2977 Updates TRN (turnaraound delay) and prescaling.fields of the
2978 Wire Control Register (WCR).
2979 No parameters: displays current settings.
2980 @end deffn
2981
2982 @subsection SPI Transport
2983 @cindex SPI
2984 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
2985 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
2986 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
2987 solution for flash programming.
2988
2989 @anchor{jtagspeed}
2990 @section JTAG Speed
2991 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
2992 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
2993 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
2994 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
2995 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
2996 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
2997 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
2998 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
2999 power management software that may be active.
3000
3001 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3002 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3003 target event handler.
3004 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3005 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3006 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3007 sets up those clocks).
3008 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3009 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3010 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3011 in the target config file.
3012 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3013 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3014 config file instead.
3015 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3016 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3017 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3018
3019 @example
3020 jtag_rclk 3000
3021 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3022 @end example
3023
3024 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3025 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3026 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3027 may not be the fastest solution.
3028
3029 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3030 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3031 which support adaptive clocking.
3032
3033 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3034 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3035 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3036 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3037 than the speed specified.
3038
3039 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3040 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3041 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3042 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3043
3044 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3045 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3046 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3047 JTAG clocking after setup.
3048 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3049 If the interface device can not
3050 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3051 @end deffn
3052
3053 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3054 @cindex adaptive clocking
3055 @cindex RTCK
3056 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3057 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3058 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3059 @example
3060 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3061 jtag_rclk 3000
3062 @end example
3063 @end defun
3064
3065 @node Reset Configuration
3066 @chapter Reset Configuration
3067 @cindex Reset Configuration
3068
3069 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3070 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3071 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3072 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3073 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3074 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3075 Please see the various board files for examples.
3076
3077 @quotation Note
3078 To maintainers and integrators:
3079 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3080 Normally the board configuration file
3081 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3082 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3083
3084 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3085 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3086 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3087 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3088 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3089 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3090 @end quotation
3091
3092 @section Types of Reset
3093
3094 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3095 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3096 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3097
3098 @itemize @bullet
3099 @item
3100 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3101 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3102 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3103 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3104 @item
3105 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3106 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3107 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3108 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3109 @item
3110 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3111 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3112 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3113 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3114 @item
3115 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3116 several other types of reset.
3117 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3118 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3119 There may be individual module resets.
3120 @end itemize
3121
3122 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3123 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3124 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3125 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3126 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3127 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3128 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3129 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3130 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3131
3132 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3133 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3134
3135 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3136 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3137 common issues are:
3138
3139 @itemize @bullet
3140
3141 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3142 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3143 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3144 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3145 when either of those signals is not connected.
3146 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3147 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3148 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3149 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3150
3151 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3152 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3153 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3154 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3155
3156 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3157 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3158 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3159 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3160 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3161 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3162 hardware debouncing.
3163 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3164 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3165
3166 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3167 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3168 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3169 to use push/pull output drivers.
3170 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3171 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3172 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3173 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3174
3175 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3176 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3177 issues (not limited to errata).
3178 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3179 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3180 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3181 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3182 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3183 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3184 @end itemize
3185
3186 There can also be other issues.
3187 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3188 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3189 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3190 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3191 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3192 Agreement (NDA).
3193
3194 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3195 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3196 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3197
3198 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3199 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3200
3201 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3202
3203 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3204 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3205 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3206 allowing it to be deasserted.
3207 @end deffn
3208
3209 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3210 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3211 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3212 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3213 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3214 @end deffn
3215
3216 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3217 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3218 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3219 allowing it to be deasserted.
3220 @end deffn
3221
3222 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3223 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3224 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3225 @end deffn
3226
3227 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3228 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3229 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3230 configuration scripts.
3231
3232 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3233 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3234 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3235 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3236 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3237 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3238 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3239 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3240
3241 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3242 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3243 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3244 -- may be specified at a time.
3245 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3246 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3247 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3248 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3249 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3250
3251 @itemize
3252 @item
3253 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3254 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3255 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3256 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3257 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3258
3259 @quotation Tip
3260 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3261 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3262 @end quotation
3263
3264 @item
3265 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3266 signal implementations.
3267 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3268 indicating everything behaves normally.
3269 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3270 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3271 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3272 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3273 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3274 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3275 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3276
3277 @item
3278 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3279 JTAG may be unvailable during reset.
3280 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3281 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3282 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3283 while SRST is asserted.
3284 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3285 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3286
3287 @item
3288 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3289 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3290 is required to use this option.
3291 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3292 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3293 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3294 be asserted before any target connection.
3295 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3296 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3297 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3298 @end itemize
3299
3300 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3301 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3302 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3303 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3304 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3305
3306 @itemize
3307 @item
3308 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3309 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3310 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3311 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3312
3313 @item
3314 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3315 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3316 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3317 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3318 powerup and pressing a reset button.
3319 @end itemize
3320 @end deffn
3321
3322 @section Custom Reset Handling
3323 @cindex events
3324
3325 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3326 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3327 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3328 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3329 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3330 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3331
3332 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3333 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3334 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3335 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3336 want to reset everything at once.
3337
3338 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3339 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3340 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3341 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3342 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3343 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3344 needs special attention.
3345
3346 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3347 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3348 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3349 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3350 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3351 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3352 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3353 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3354
3355 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3356 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3357 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3358 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3359 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3360
3361 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3362 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3363 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3364 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3365 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3366 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3367 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3368 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3369 or potentially some other value.
3370
3371 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3372 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3373 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3374 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3375 (or their associated targets)
3376 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3377
3378 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3379 they return.
3380 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3381 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3382 @end deffn
3383
3384 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3385 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3386 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3387 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3388 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3389 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3390 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3391 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3392 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3393 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3394 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3395 @end deffn
3396
3397 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3398 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3399 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3400 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3401 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3402 @end deffn
3403
3404
3405 @node TAP Declaration
3406 @chapter TAP Declaration
3407 @cindex TAP declaration
3408 @cindex TAP configuration
3409
3410 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3411 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3412
3413 @itemize @bullet
3414 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3415 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3416 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3417 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3418 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3419 start running that code.
3420 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3421 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3422 and missing connections.
3423 @end itemize
3424
3425 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3426 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3427 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3428 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3429 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3430
3431 @section Scan Chains
3432 @cindex scan chain
3433
3434 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3435 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3436 They also need to be added to
3437 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3438 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3439 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3440 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3441 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3442 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3443 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3444 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3445
3446 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3447 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3448 command, presented in the next chapter.
3449 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3450 debugging targets.)
3451 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3452
3453 @verbatim
3454 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3455 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3456 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3457 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3458 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3459 @end verbatim
3460
3461 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3462 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3463 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3464 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3465 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3466 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3467 until they are told to do so.
3468
3469 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3470 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3471 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3472 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3473
3474 @example
3475 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3476 @end example
3477
3478 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3479 by a given chip.
3480 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3481 and so forth.
3482 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3483 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3484 both inside a single chip and between them.
3485 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3486
3487 For example, the ST Microsystems STR912 chip has
3488 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3489 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3490 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3491 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3492 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3493 includes commands something like this:
3494
3495 @example
3496 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3497 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3498 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3499 @end example
3500
3501 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3502 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3503 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3504
3505 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3506 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3507 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3508 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3509 @example
3510 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3511 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3512 @}
3513 @end example
3514 @end deffn
3515
3516 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3517 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3518 and their status.
3519 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3520 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3521 but systems with a JTAG router can
3522 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3523 @end deffn
3524
3525 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3526 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3527
3528 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3529 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3530
3531 @section TAP Names
3532 @cindex dotted name
3533
3534 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3535 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3536 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3537 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3538 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3539 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3540 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3541 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3542
3543 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3544 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3545 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3546
3547 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3548
3549 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3550 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3551 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3552 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3553
3554 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3555 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3556 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3557 overridable.
3558
3559 @cindex TAP naming convention
3560 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3561 and should follow this convention:
3562
3563 @itemize @bullet
3564 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3565 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3566 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3567 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3568 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3569 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3570 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3571 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3572 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3573 with a single TAP;
3574 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3575 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3576 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3577 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3578 @end itemize
3579
3580 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3581
3582 @itemize @bullet
3583 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3584 @*The length in bits of the
3585 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3586 @end itemize
3587
3588 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3589
3590 @itemize @bullet
3591 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3592 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3593 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3594 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3595 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3596 (the TAP is linked in).
3597 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3598 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3599 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3600 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3601 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3602 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3603 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3604 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3605 values that were found but not included in the list.
3606
3607 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3608 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3609 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3610 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3611 hardware to find these values.
3612 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3613 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3614 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3615 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3616 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3617 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3618 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3619 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3620 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3621 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3622 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3623 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3624 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3625 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3626 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3627 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3628 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3629 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3630 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3631 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3632 @end itemize
3633 @end deffn
3634
3635 @section Other TAP commands
3636
3637 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3638 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3639 At this writing this TAP attribute
3640 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3641 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3642 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3643 See the next section for information about the available events.
3644
3645 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3646 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3647 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3648 @end deffn
3649
3650 @section TAP Events
3651 @cindex events
3652 @cindex TAP events
3653
3654 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3655 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3656 The other applies to debugger targets,
3657 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3658
3659 The TAP events currently defined are:
3660
3661 @itemize @bullet
3662 @item @b{post-reset}
3663 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3664 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3665 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3666 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3667 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3668
3669 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3670 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3671 of any particular target.
3672 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3673 @item @b{setup}
3674 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3675 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3676 @item @b{tap-disable}
3677 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3678 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3679 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3680 @item @b{tap-enable}
3681 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3682 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3683 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3684 @end itemize
3685
3686 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3687 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3688 contents to be accurate), you might:
3689
3690 @example
3691 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3692 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3693 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3694 @}
3695 @end example
3696
3697
3698 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3699 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3700 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3701 @cindex jrc
3702
3703 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3704 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3705 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3706 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3707 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3708
3709 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3710 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3711 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3712 be visible.
3713 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3714 ignores, such as:
3715
3716 @itemize
3717 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3718 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3719 TAPs receive new instructions.
3720 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3721 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3722 @end itemize
3723
3724 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3725 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3726 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3727 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3728
3729 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3730 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3731
3732 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3733 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3734 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3735 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3736 should define TAP event handlers using
3737 code that looks something like this:
3738
3739 @example
3740 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3741 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3742 @}
3743 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3744 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3745 @}
3746 @end example
3747
3748 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3749
3750 @example
3751 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3752 @end example
3753
3754 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3755 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3756 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3757 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3758
3759 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3760 If necessary, disables the tap
3761 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3762 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3763 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3764 and "0" if it is disabled.
3765 @end deffn
3766
3767 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3768 If necessary, enables the tap
3769 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3770 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3771 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3772 and "0" if it is disabled.
3773 @end deffn
3774
3775 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3776 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3777 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3778 and "0" if it is disabled.
3779
3780 @quotation Note
3781 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3782 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3783 @end quotation
3784 @end deffn
3785
3786 @anchor{autoprobing}
3787 @section Autoprobing
3788 @cindex autoprobe
3789 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3790
3791 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3792 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3793 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3794 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3795
3796 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3797 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3798 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3799 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3800 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3801 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3802 right when they come out of reset).
3803
3804 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3805
3806 @example
3807 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3808 reset_config trst_and_srst
3809 jtag_rclk 8
3810 @end example
3811
3812 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3813 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3814
3815 @enumerate
3816 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3817 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3818 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3819 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3820 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3821 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3822 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3823 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3824 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3825 that is discovered.
3826 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
3827 register, it will report it.
3828 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
3829 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
3830 @end enumerate
3831
3832 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
3833 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
3834 that's a bit more complex:
3835
3836 @example
3837 clock speed 8 kHz
3838 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
3839 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
3840 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
3841 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
3842 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3843 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
3844 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
3845 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
3846 @end example
3847
3848 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
3849 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
3850 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
3851 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
3852 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
3853 and so forth.
3854
3855 @node CPU Configuration
3856 @chapter CPU Configuration
3857 @cindex GDB target
3858
3859 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
3860 You can also access these targets without GDB
3861 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
3862 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
3863 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
3864 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
3865
3866 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
3867 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
3868
3869 @section Target List
3870 @cindex target, current
3871 @cindex target, list
3872
3873 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
3874 where each member has a name.
3875 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
3876 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
3877 (plural!) command.
3878 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
3879 look like with more than one:
3880 @verbatim
3881 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
3882 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
3883 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
3884 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
3885 @end verbatim
3886
3887 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
3888 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
3889 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
3890 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
3891 space seen by that current target.
3892 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
3893 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
3894 are examples; and there are many more.
3895
3896 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
3897
3898 @deffn Command {target current}
3899 Returns the name of the current target.
3900 @end deffn
3901
3902 @deffn Command {target names}
3903 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
3904 @example
3905 foreach t [target names] @{
3906 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
3907 @}
3908 @end example
3909 @end deffn
3910
3911 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
3912 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
3913
3914 @deffn Command targets [name]
3915 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
3916 command names are singular.}
3917
3918 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
3919 targets in a user friendly form.
3920
3921 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
3922 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
3923 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
3924 @end deffn
3925
3926 @section Target CPU Types
3927 @cindex target type
3928 @cindex CPU type
3929
3930 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
3931 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
3932 when calling @command{target create}.
3933 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
3934 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
3935 what kind of debug support it integrates,
3936 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
3937 what core-specific commands may be available
3938 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
3939 and more.
3940
3941 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
3942 since there's a command to list them.
3943
3944 @anchor{targettypes}
3945 @deffn Command {target types}
3946 Lists all supported target types.
3947 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
3948
3949 @itemize @bullet
3950 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
3951 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
3952 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
3953 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
3954 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
3955 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
3956 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
3957 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
3958 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
3959 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
3960 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
3961 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
3962 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
3963 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
3964 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
3965 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
3966 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
3967 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
3968 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
3969 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
3970 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
3971 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
3972 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
3973 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
3974 @itemize @minus
3975 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
3976 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
3977 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
3978 @end itemize
3979 And two debug interfaces cores:
3980 @itemize @minus
3981 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
3982 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
3983 @end itemize
3984 @end itemize
3985 @end deffn
3986
3987 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
3988 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
3989 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
3990 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
3991 licenced, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
3992 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
3993 reflect design generations;
3994 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, and ARMv7
3995 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
3996
3997 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
3998 @section Target Configuration
3999
4000 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4001 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4002 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4003 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4004 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4005
4006 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4007 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4008 optional parts.
4009 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4010 command, created as part of target creation.
4011
4012 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4013 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4014 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4015 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4016 to be much more board-specific.
4017 The key steps you use might look something like this
4018
4019 @example
4020 target create MyTarget cortex_m -chain-position mychip.cpu
4021 $MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4022 $MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4023 $MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4024 @end example
4025
4026 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4027 on-chip SRAM.
4028 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4029 writes to target memory;
4030 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4031 GDB memory checksumming;
4032 and more.
4033
4034 @quotation Warning
4035 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4036 inaccessible when application code
4037 (such as an operating system)
4038 enables or disables the MMU.
4039 For example, the particular MMU context used to acess the virtual
4040 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4041 easy access to other addresses needed.
4042 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4043 @end quotation
4044
4045 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4046 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4047 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4048 controllers.
4049 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4050 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4051 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4052
4053 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4054 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4055 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4056 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4057 purposes including additional configuration.
4058
4059 @itemize @bullet
4060 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4061 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4062 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4063 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4064
4065 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4066 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4067 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4068 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4069 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4070 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4071 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4072
4073 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} here.
4074 @end itemize
4075 @end deffn
4076
4077 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4078 The options accepted by this command may also be
4079 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4080 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4081 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4082
4083 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4084 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4085 and changing its endianness.
4086
4087 @itemize @bullet
4088
4089 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4090 used to access this target.
4091
4092 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4093 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4094
4095 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4096 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4097 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4098 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4099 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4100 same event name assigns only one handler.
4101
4102 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4103 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4104 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4105 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4106 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4107 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4108 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4109
4110 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4111 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4112 or virtual address is being used.
4113
4114 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4115 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4116
4117 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4118 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4119 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4120 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4121 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4122
4123 @anchor{rtostype}
4124 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4125 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}|@option{eCos}|@option{ThreadX}|
4126 @option{FreeRTOS}|@option{linux}|@option{ChibiOS}|@option{embKernel}|@option{mqx}
4127 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4128
4129 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4130 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4131 access the target for debugging.
4132
4133 @end itemize
4134 @end deffn
4135
4136 @section Other $target_name Commands
4137 @cindex object command
4138
4139 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4140 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4141
4142 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4143 Once a button is created a button
4144 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4145 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4146 configure it like this:
4147
4148 @example
4149 # Create
4150 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4151 # Modify
4152 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4153 # Query
4154 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4155 # Report
4156 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4157 @end example
4158
4159 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4160 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4161
4162 @example
4163 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4164 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4165 @end example
4166
4167 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4168
4169 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4170 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4171 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4172 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4173 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4174 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4175 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4176 They are not otherwise documented here.
4177 @end deffn
4178
4179 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4180 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4181 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4182 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4183 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4184 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4185 the target side uses raw memory.
4186
4187 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4188 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4189 The script orientation comes from working with data
4190 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4191 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4192 and neither store nor return those values.
4193
4194 @itemize
4195 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4196 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4197 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4198 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4199 @end itemize
4200 @end deffn
4201
4202 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4203 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4204 @command{$target_name configure}
4205 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4206 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4207 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4208 There are a few special cases:
4209
4210 @itemize @bullet
4211 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4212 event named @var{event_name}.
4213 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4214 two parameters.
4215 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4216 This is a special case because this is set using
4217 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4218 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4219 @end itemize
4220
4221 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4222 all the targets you might use something like this:
4223
4224 @example
4225 foreach name [target names] @{
4226 set y [$name cget -endian]
4227 set z [$name cget -type]
4228 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4229 $x $name $y $z]
4230 @}
4231 @end example
4232 @end deffn
4233
4234 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4235 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4236 Displays the current target state:
4237 @code{debug-running},
4238 @code{halted},
4239 @code{reset},
4240 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4241 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4242 @end deffn
4243
4244 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4245 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4246 currently associated with this target.
4247 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4248 @end deffn
4249
4250 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4251 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4252 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4253 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4254 @end deffn
4255
4256 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4257 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4258 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4259 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4260 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4261 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4262 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4263 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4264 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4265 @end deffn
4266
4267 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4268 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4269 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4270 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4271 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4272 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4273 @end deffn
4274
4275 @anchor{targetevents}
4276 @section Target Events
4277 @cindex target events
4278 @cindex events
4279 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4280 For example:
4281 @itemize @bullet
4282 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4283 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4284 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4285 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4286 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4287 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4288 to set up system clocks or
4289 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4290 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4291 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4292 @end itemize
4293
4294 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4295 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4296 @command{target create ... -event}.
4297
4298 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4299 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4300 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4301
4302 @example
4303 proc my_attach_proc @{ @} @{
4304 echo "Reset..."
4305 reset halt
4306 @}
4307 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach my_attach_proc
4308 mychip.cpu configure -event gdb-attach @{
4309 echo "Reset..."
4310 # To make flash probe and gdb load to flash work
4311 # we need a reset init.
4312 reset init
4313 @}
4314 @end example
4315
4316 The following target events are defined:
4317
4318 @itemize @bullet
4319 @item @b{debug-halted}
4320 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4321 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4322 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: gdb said run)
4323 @item @b{early-halted}
4324 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4325 @item @b{examine-start}
4326 @* Before target examine is called.
4327 @item @b{examine-end}
4328 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4329 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4330 @* When GDB connects. This is before any communication with the target, so this
4331 can be used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash. Probing flash
4332 is necessary during gdb connect if gdb load is to write the image to flash. Another
4333 use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically hardware/software breakpoints
4334 depending on whether the breakpoint is in RAM or read only memory.
4335 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4336 @* When GDB disconnects
4337 @item @b{gdb-end}
4338 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4339 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4340 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4341 @code{reset init})
4342 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4343 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4344 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4345 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4346 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4347 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4348 @item @b{gdb-start}
4349 @* Before the target steps, gdb is trying to start/resume the target
4350 @item @b{halted}
4351 @* The target has halted
4352 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4353 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4354 after @command{reset_init} was triggered
4355 but before either SRST alone is re-asserted on the scan chain,
4356 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4357 @item @b{reset-assert}
4358 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4359 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4360 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4361 it instead of asserting SRST.
4362 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4363 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4364 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4365 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4366 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4367 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4368 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4369 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4370 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4371 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4372 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4373 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4374 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4375 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4376 released on the scan chain.
4377 @item @b{reset-end}
4378 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4379 @ignore
4380 @item @b{reset-halt-post}
4381 @* Currently not used
4382 @item @b{reset-halt-pre}
4383 @* Currently not used
4384 @end ignore
4385 @item @b{reset-init}
4386 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4387 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4388
4389 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4390 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4391 multiplexing, and so on.
4392 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4393 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4394 @item @b{reset-start}
4395 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4396 before @command{reset_init} is called.
4397
4398 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4399 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4400 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4401 @ignore
4402 @item @b{reset-wait-pos}
4403 @* Currently not used
4404 @item @b{reset-wait-pre}
4405 @* Currently not used
4406 @end ignore
4407 @item @b{resume-start}
4408 @* Before any target is resumed
4409 @item @b{resume-end}
4410 @* After all targets have resumed
4411 @item @b{resumed}
4412 @* Target has resumed
4413 @item @b{trace-config}
4414 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4415 @end itemize
4416
4417 @node Flash Commands
4418 @chapter Flash Commands
4419
4420 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4421 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4422 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4423 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4424 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4425 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4426 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4427 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4428 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4429
4430 Flash Steps:
4431 @enumerate
4432 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4433 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4434 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4435 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4436 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4437 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4438 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4439 @item GDB Flashing
4440 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4441 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4442 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4443 @end enumerate
4444
4445 Many CPUs have the ablity to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4446 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4447 so that it can't boot.
4448 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4449 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4450
4451 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4452 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4453 @cindex flash configuration
4454
4455 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4456 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4457 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4458 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4459 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4460 see the driver-specific documentation.
4461
4462 @itemize @bullet
4463 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4464 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4465 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4466 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4467 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4468 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4469 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4470 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4471 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4472 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4473 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4474 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4475 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4476 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4477 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4478 commands to the flash controller.
4479 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4480 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4481 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4482 for more information.
4483 @end itemize
4484 @quotation Note
4485 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4486 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4487 @end quotation
4488 @end deffn
4489
4490 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4491 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4492 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4493 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4494 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4495 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4496 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4497 @end deffn
4498
4499 @deffn Command {flash list}
4500 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4501 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4502 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4503 @end deffn
4504
4505 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4506 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4507 depends on the flash type.
4508 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4509 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4510 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4511 but most don't bother.
4512 @end deffn
4513
4514 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4515 @cindex flash erasing
4516 @cindex flash reading
4517 @cindex flash writing
4518 @cindex flash programming
4519 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4520
4521 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4522 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressible memory.
4523 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4524 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4525 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4526
4527 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4528 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4529 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4530 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4531 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4532
4533 @quotation Note
4534 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4535 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4536 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4537 back to a flash bank.
4538 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4539 @comment with that target doesn't succesfuly autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4540 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4541 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4542 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4543 @end quotation
4544
4545 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4546 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4547 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4548 disabled first.
4549 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4550 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4551 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4552
4553 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4554 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4555 up to and including @var{last}.
4556 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4557 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4558 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4559 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4560 @end deffn
4561
4562 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4563 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4564 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4565 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4566 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4567 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4568 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4569 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4570 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4571 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4572 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4573 before erase starts.
4574 @end deffn
4575
4576 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4577 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4578 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4579 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4580 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4581 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4582 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4583 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4584 before issuing this command.
4585 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4586 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4587 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4588 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4589 @end deffn
4590 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4591
4592 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename offset
4593 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4594 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
4595 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4596 @end deffn
4597
4598 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename offset length
4599 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4600 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}.
4601 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4602 @end deffn
4603
4604 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename offset
4605 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4606 flash @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. Fails if the contents do not match.
4607 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4608 @end deffn
4609
4610 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4611 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4612 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4613 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4614 to the base address for each section in the image.
4615 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4616 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4617 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4618 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4619 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4620 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4621 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4622 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4623 each image section.
4624
4625 @quotation Warning
4626 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4627 data you want to preserve.
4628 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4629 sections might be erased with no notice.
4630 @itemize
4631 @item
4632 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4633 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4634 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4635 @item
4636 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4637 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4638 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4639 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4640 @end itemize
4641 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4642 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4643 @end quotation
4644
4645 @end deffn
4646
4647 @section Other Flash commands
4648 @cindex flash protection
4649
4650 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4651 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4652 and display that status.
4653 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4654 @end deffn
4655
4656 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
4657 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
4658 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
4659
4660 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4661 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
4662 and possibly stale information.
4663 @end deffn
4664
4665 @anchor{flashprotect}
4666 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
4667 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash sectors
4668 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4669 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
4670 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4671 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4672 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4673 @end deffn
4674
4675 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
4676 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
4677 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
4678 comamnd or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
4679 @end deffn
4680
4681 @anchor{program}
4682 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
4683 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
4684 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
4685 @xref{Flash Programming}.
4686 @end deffn
4687
4688 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
4689 @section Flash Driver List
4690 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
4691 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
4692 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
4693
4694 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
4695 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
4696 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
4697
4698 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
4699
4700 @itemize
4701 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
4702 @end itemize
4703
4704 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
4705 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any cmds executed on
4706 the virtual banks are actually performed on the physical banks.
4707 @example
4708 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4709 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4710 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
4711 @end example
4712 @end deffn
4713
4714 @subsection External Flash
4715
4716 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
4717 @cindex Common Flash Interface
4718 @cindex CFI
4719 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
4720 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
4721 specific external chip select on the CPU.
4722 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
4723 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
4724 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
4725 configure a bus and its timings), or
4726 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
4727 on the flash chip.
4728 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
4729 speed up operation.
4730
4731 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
4732
4733 @itemize
4734 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
4735 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
4736 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
4737 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
4738 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
4739 swapped when writing data values (ie. not CFI commands).
4740 @end itemize
4741
4742 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
4743 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
4744
4745 @example
4746 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4747 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
4748 @end example
4749
4750 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
4751 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
4752 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
4753
4754 @example
4755 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
4756 @end example
4757
4758 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
4759 @end deffn
4760
4761 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
4762 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
4763 @cindex SPI
4764 @cindex jtagspi
4765 @cindex bscan_spi
4766 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
4767 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
4768 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
4769 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
4770 accessed through JTAG.
4771
4772 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
4773 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
4774 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
4775 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
4776 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires migen
4777 (@url{http://github.com/m-labs/migen}) and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
4778
4779 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
4780 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
4781 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
4782 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
4783 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
4784 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
4785 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
4786 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
4787
4788 @itemize
4789 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
4790 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
4791 @var{USER1} instruction.
4792 @item @var{dr_length} ... is the length of the DR register. This will be 1 for
4793 @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} bitstreams and most other cases.
4794 @end itemize
4795
4796 @example
4797 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
4798 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
4799 set _DR_LENGTH 1
4800 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1 $_DR_LENGTH
4801 @end example
4802 @end deffn
4803
4804 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
4805 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
4806 @cindex SPIFI
4807 @cindex lpcspifi
4808 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
4809 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
4810 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
4811
4812 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
4813 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
4814 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
4815 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
4816 significantly reduce flash programming times.
4817
4818 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
4819 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
4820 are configured by the driver.
4821
4822 @example
4823 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4824 @end example
4825
4826 @end deffn
4827
4828 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
4829 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
4830 @cindex SMI
4831 @cindex stmsmi
4832 Some devices form STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
4833 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
4834 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
4835 SPI flash devices.
4836 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
4837 flash devices can be connected.
4838
4839 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
4840 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
4841 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
4842 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
4843 the flash content.
4844
4845 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
4846 to identify the memory bank.
4847 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
4848 flash size, are detected automatically.
4849
4850 @example
4851 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4852 @end example
4853
4854 @end deffn
4855
4856 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
4857 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
4858 Microcontroller platform.
4859
4860 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
4861 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
4862
4863 @example
4864 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
4865 @end example
4866
4867 @end deffn
4868
4869 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
4870
4871 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
4872 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
4873 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
4874 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
4875 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
4876 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
4877
4878 @example
4879 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4880 @end example
4881 @end deffn
4882
4883 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
4884 @cindex ambiqmicro
4885 @cindex apollo
4886 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
4887 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
4888 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
4889 with the target using SWD.
4890
4891 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
4892 the device class of the MCU.
4893 The Flash and Sram sizes directly follow device class, and are used
4894 to set up the flash banks.
4895 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
4896 sizes of an Apollo chip.
4897
4898 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
4899 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
4900 and the second bank starts after the first.
4901
4902 @example
4903 # Flash bank 0
4904 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4905 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
4906 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
4907 @end example
4908
4909 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
4910 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
4911 are available to the user.
4912
4913 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
4914
4915 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
4916 Erase entire bank.
4917 @end deffn
4918 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
4919 Erase device pages.
4920 @end deffn
4921 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
4922 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
4923 The user writes sectors to sram starting at 0x10000010.
4924 Program OTP will write these sectors from sram to flash, and write protect
4925 the flash.
4926 @end deffn
4927 @end deffn
4928
4929 @anchor{at91samd}
4930 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
4931 @cindex at91samd
4932 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
4933 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
4934 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
4935
4936 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
4937 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
4938 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
4939 processor to be halted.
4940 @end deffn
4941
4942 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
4943 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
4944 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
4945 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
4946 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
4947 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
4948
4949 @example
4950 at91samd set-security enable
4951 @end example
4952 @end deffn
4953
4954 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
4955 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
4956 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
4957 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
4958 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
4959 requires additional firmware support and the minumum EEPROM size may not be
4960 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
4961 in order to disable this feature.
4962
4963 @example
4964 at91samd eeprom
4965 at91samd eeprom 1024
4966 @end example
4967 @end deffn
4968
4969 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
4970 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
4971 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
4972 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
4973 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
4974 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
4975
4976 @example
4977 at91samd bootloader
4978 at91samd bootloader 16384
4979 @end example
4980 @end deffn
4981
4982 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
4983 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
4984 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
4985 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
4986 @end deffn
4987
4988 @end deffn
4989
4990 @anchor{at91sam3}
4991 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
4992 @cindex at91sam3
4993 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
4994 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
4995 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
4996 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
4997 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
4998 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
4999 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrysome comment after other
5000 chips are confirmed.}
5001
5002 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5003 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5004 the following fixed locations:
5005
5006 @example
5007 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5008 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5009 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5010 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5011 @end example
5012
5013 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5014 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5015 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5016
5017 @itemize
5018 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5019 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5020 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5021 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5022 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5023 @end itemize
5024
5025 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5026
5027 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5028 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5029 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5030 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5031 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5032 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5033 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5034
5035 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5036 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5037 @end deffn
5038
5039 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5040 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5041 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5042 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5043 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5044 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5045 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5046 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5047 @end deffn
5048
5049 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5050 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5051 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5052 @end deffn
5053 @end deffn
5054
5055 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5056 @cindex at91sam4
5057 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5058 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5059 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5060 @end deffn
5061
5062 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5063 @cindex at91sam4l
5064 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5065 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5066 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5067
5068 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5069 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5070 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5071 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5072 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5073 @end deffn
5074 @end deffn
5075
5076 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5077 @cindex atsamv
5078 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5079 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5080 This driver uses the same cmd names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5081 @end deffn
5082
5083 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5084 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5085 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5086 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5087 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5088
5089 @example
5090 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5091 @end example
5092
5093 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5094 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5095
5096 @itemize
5097 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5098 @item @var{banks}
5099 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5100 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5101 @item @var{pages_size}
5102 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5103 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5104 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5105 @end itemize
5106
5107 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5108 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5109 will be autoconfigured.
5110 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5111
5112 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5113 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5114 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5115 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5116 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5117
5118 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5119 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5120 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5121 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5122 are not truly general purpose).
5123 @quotation Note
5124 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5125 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5126 @end quotation
5127 @end deffn
5128 @end deffn
5129
5130 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5131 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5132 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5133 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5134 @end deffn
5135
5136 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5137 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5138 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5139 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5140 autoconfigures itself.
5141 @example
5142 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5143 @end example
5144 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5145 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5146 this via the following command:
5147 @example
5148 efm32 debuglock num
5149 @end example
5150 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5151 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5152 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5153 supported.}
5154 @end deffn
5155
5156 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5157 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5158 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5159 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5160 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5161 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5162 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5163
5164 @example
5165 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5166 @end example
5167 @end deffn
5168
5169 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5170 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5171 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5172 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5173 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5174 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5175 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5176 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5177 characters) ignored.
5178
5179 @example
5180 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5181 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5182 @end example
5183 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5184 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5185 @end deffn
5186
5187 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5188 @cindex kinetis
5189 Kx and KLx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5190 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5191 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5192 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5193
5194 @example
5195 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5196 @end example
5197
5198 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5199 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5200 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5201 set by 'flash protect' command.
5202 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5203 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5204 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5205 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5206 with the rest of a flash image.
5207 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5208 @end deffn
5209
5210 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5211 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5212 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5213 @end deffn
5214
5215 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5216 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5217 @end deffn
5218
5219 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5220 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5221 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5222 @end deffn
5223
5224 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5225 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5226 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5227 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5228 command completes.
5229 @end deffn
5230
5231 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5232 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5233 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5234 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5235 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5236
5237 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5238 Program Partition command.
5239
5240 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5241 Reset the device after partition setting.
5242
5243 Show partition size:
5244 @example
5245 kinetis nvm_partition info
5246 @end example
5247
5248 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5249 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5250 @example
5251 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5252 @end example
5253
5254 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5255 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5256 @example
5257 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5258 @end example
5259 @end deffn
5260
5261 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5262 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5263 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5264 @end deffn
5265
5266 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5267 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5268 Command disables watchdog timer.
5269 @end deffn
5270 @end deffn
5271
5272 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5273 @cindex kinetis_ke
5274 KE members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from Freescale include
5275 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5276 the KE family and sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5277 autoconfigures itself.
5278
5279 @example
5280 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5281 @end example
5282
5283 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5284 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5285 @end deffn
5286
5287 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5288 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5289 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5290 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5291 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5292 @end deffn
5293
5294 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5295 Command disables watchdog timer.
5296 @end deffn
5297 @end deffn
5298
5299 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5300 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5301 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5302 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5303 microcontroller families from NXP.
5304
5305 @quotation Note
5306 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5307 driver:
5308 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5309 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5310 @end quotation
5311
5312 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5313 which must appear in the following order:
5314
5315 @itemize
5316 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5317 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5318 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5319 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5320 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5321 LPC43x[2357])
5322 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5323 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5324 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5325 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5326 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5327 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5328 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5329 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5330 at which the core is running
5331 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5332 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5333 @quotation Note
5334 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5335 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5336 However, if you do provide it,
5337 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5338 @end quotation
5339 @end itemize
5340
5341 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5342
5343 @example
5344 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5345 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5346 @end example
5347
5348 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5349 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5350 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5351 @end deffn
5352 @end deffn
5353
5354 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5355 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5356 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5357 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5358 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5359 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5360
5361 @example
5362 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5363 @end example
5364 @end deffn
5365
5366 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5367 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5368 from NXP.
5369
5370 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5371 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5372 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5373 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5374 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5375 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5376 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5377 you start the PLL.
5378
5379 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5380
5381 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5382 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5383 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5384
5385 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5386 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5387 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5388 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5389 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5390 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5391 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5392
5393 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5394 @example
5395 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5396 @end example
5397
5398 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5399 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5400 @code{flash banks} command.
5401
5402 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5403 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5404 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5405 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5406 a known signature.
5407 Example:
5408 @example
5409 lpc2900 signature 0
5410 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5411 @end example
5412 @end deffn
5413
5414 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5415 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5416 saves it to a file in binary format.
5417 Example:
5418 @example
5419 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5420 @end example
5421 @end deffn
5422
5423 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5424 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5425 commands need to be preceeded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5426 command:
5427
5428 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5429 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5430 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5431 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5432
5433 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5434 Example:
5435 @example
5436 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5437 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5438 @end example
5439 @end deffn
5440
5441 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5442 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5443 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5444 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5445 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5446 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5447 912 bytes.
5448 @quotation Attention
5449 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5450 @end quotation
5451 Example:
5452 @example
5453 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5454 @end example
5455 @end deffn
5456
5457 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5458 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5459 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5460 after the next power cycle.
5461 @quotation Attention
5462 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5463 @end quotation
5464 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5465 Example:
5466 @example
5467 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
5468 flash info 0
5469 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
5470 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5471 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
5472 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
5473 @end example
5474 @end deffn
5475
5476 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
5477 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
5478 effective after the next power cycle.
5479 @quotation Attention
5480 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5481 @end quotation
5482 Examples:
5483 @example
5484 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
5485 @end example
5486 @end deffn
5487 @end deffn
5488
5489 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
5490 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
5491 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
5492 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
5493
5494 @example
5495 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
5496 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
5497 @end example
5498
5499 @itemize @bullet
5500 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
5501 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
5502 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
5503 @end itemize
5504
5505 Example usage:
5506 @example
5507 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
5508 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
5509 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
5510 @} else @{
5511 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
5512 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
5513 @}
5514 @end example
5515 @end deffn
5516
5517 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
5518 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
5519 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5520 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
5521 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
5522 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
5523 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
5524 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
5525 also have division into regions: main and info.
5526 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
5527 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memmory.
5528
5529 @example
5530 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5531 @end example
5532
5533 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
5534
5535 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
5536 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
5537 @end deffn
5538
5539 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
5540 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
5541 @end deffn
5542
5543 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
5544 Erase all userflash including info region.
5545 @end deffn
5546
5547 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
5548 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5549 @end deffn
5550
5551 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
5552 Check sectors protect.
5553 @end deffn
5554
5555 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
5556 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
5557 @end deffn
5558
5559 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
5560 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
5561 @end deffn
5562
5563 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
5564 Configure external memory interface for boot.
5565 @end deffn
5566
5567 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
5568 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
5569 @end deffn
5570
5571 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
5572 Show information about flash driver.
5573 @end deffn
5574
5575 @end deffn
5576
5577 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf51
5578 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
5579 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
5580
5581 @example
5582 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf51 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5583 @end example
5584
5585 Some nrf51-specific commands are defined:
5586
5587 @deffn Command {nrf51 mass_erase}
5588 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
5589 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
5590 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
5591 code.
5592 @end deffn
5593
5594 @end deffn
5595
5596 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
5597 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
5598 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
5599
5600 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
5601 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
5602 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
5603 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
5604
5605 @example
5606 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5607 @end example
5608 @end deffn
5609
5610 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
5611 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
5612 and integrate flash memory.
5613
5614 @example
5615 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5616 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5617 @end example
5618
5619 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
5620 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5621 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
5622 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
5623 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
5624 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
5625 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
5626 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
5627 @end deffn
5628 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
5629 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
5630 This will remove any Code Protection.
5631 @end deffn
5632 @end deffn
5633
5634 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
5635 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
5636 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
5637 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5638 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5639
5640 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
5641 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
5642
5643 @example
5644 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5645 @end example
5646
5647 psoc4-specific commands
5648 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
5649 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
5650
5651 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
5652 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
5653
5654 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
5655 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
5656 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
5657
5658 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5659 @end deffn
5660
5661 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
5662 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
5663
5664 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5665 @end deffn
5666 @end deffn
5667
5668 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
5669 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
5670 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
5671 and SWD interface.
5672 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
5673 If this failes, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
5674
5675 @example
5676 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5677 @end example
5678
5679 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
5680
5681 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
5682 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
5683 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
5684 @end deffn
5685
5686 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
5687 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
5688 @end deffn
5689 @end deffn
5690
5691 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
5692 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
5693 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
5694 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
5695 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5696 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stellaris mass_erase} command.
5697 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5698 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5699
5700 @example
5701 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5702 @end example
5703
5704 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
5705 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
5706 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
5707 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
5708 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
5709 disabled.
5710
5711 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
5712 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
5713 @quotation Warning
5714 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
5715 applied to all of them.
5716 @end quotation
5717 @end deffn
5718 @end deffn
5719
5720 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
5721 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
5722 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
5723 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5724 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5725
5726 @example
5727 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5728 @end example
5729
5730 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5731 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5732 the flash driver.
5733
5734 @example
5735 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5736 @end example
5737
5738 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
5739 as per the following example.
5740 @example
5741 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5742 @end example
5743
5744 Some stm32f1x-specific commands
5745 @footnote{Currently there is a @command{stm32f1x mass_erase} command.
5746 That seems pointless since the same effect can be had using the
5747 standard @command{flash erase_address} command.}
5748 are defined:
5749
5750 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
5751 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5752 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5753 @end deffn
5754
5755 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
5756 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5757 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5758 @end deffn
5759
5760 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
5761 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
5762 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
5763 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5764 @end deffn
5765
5766 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
5767 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
5768 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5769 @end deffn
5770 @end deffn
5771
5772 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
5773 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5774 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
5775 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5776 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5777
5778 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5779 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5780 the flash driver.
5781
5782 @example
5783 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5784 @end example
5785
5786 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
5787
5788 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
5789 Locks the entire stm32 device.
5790 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5791 @end deffn
5792
5793 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
5794 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
5795 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5796 @end deffn
5797
5798 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
5799 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1.
5800 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5801 @end deffn
5802
5803 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
5804 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
5805 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
5806 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, user_options a
5807 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, boot_addr0 and boot_addr1
5808 two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
5809 @end deffn
5810 @end deffn
5811
5812 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
5813 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
5814 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
5815 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
5816 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5817
5818 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
5819 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
5820 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
5821 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
5822 second bank.
5823
5824 @example
5825 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5826 @end example
5827
5828 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
5829
5830 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
5831 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
5832 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
5833 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
5834 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5835 @end deffn
5836 @end deffn
5837
5838 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
5839 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5840 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5841 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
5842 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
5843
5844 @example
5845 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
5846 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
5847 @end example
5848
5849 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
5850 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
5851 for the specified flash bank.
5852 @end deffn
5853 @end deffn
5854
5855 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
5856 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
5857 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
5858 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
5859 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
5860
5861 @example
5862 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5863 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
5864 @end example
5865
5866 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
5867 Configures the str9 flash controller.
5868 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5869
5870 @itemize @bullet
5871 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
5872 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
5873 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5874 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
5875 @end itemize
5876 @end deffn
5877
5878 @end deffn
5879
5880 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
5881 @cindex str9xpec
5882
5883 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
5884 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
5885 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
5886 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
5887
5888 Here is some background info to help
5889 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
5890 the str9:
5891 @enumerate
5892 @item
5893 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
5894 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
5895 @item
5896 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
5897 ISC compilant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
5898 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
5899 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
5900 @end enumerate
5901
5902 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
5903 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
5904 configured for flash bank 0.
5905 @example
5906 # assert srst, we do not want core running
5907 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
5908 jtag_reset 0 1
5909 # turn off target polling
5910 poll off
5911 # disable str9 core
5912 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
5913 # read option bytes
5914 str9xpec options_read 0
5915 # re-enable str9 core
5916 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
5917 poll on
5918 reset halt
5919 @end example
5920 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
5921 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
5922 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
5923 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
5924
5925 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
5926
5927 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
5928 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
5929 @end deffn
5930
5931 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
5932 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
5933 directly to the embedded flash controller.
5934 @end deffn
5935
5936 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
5937 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
5938 erase the device.
5939 @end deffn
5940
5941 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
5942 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
5943 @end deffn
5944
5945 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
5946 Configure str9 boot bank.
5947 @end deffn
5948
5949 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5950 Configure str9 lvd source.
5951 @end deffn
5952
5953 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
5954 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
5955 @end deffn
5956
5957 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
5958 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
5959 @end deffn
5960
5961 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
5962 Read str9 option bytes.
5963 @end deffn
5964
5965 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
5966 Write str9 option bytes.
5967 @end deffn
5968
5969 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
5970 unlock str9 device.
5971 @end deffn
5972
5973 @end deffn
5974
5975 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
5976 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
5977 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5978 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5979
5980 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
5981
5982 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
5983 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
5984 @end deffn
5985
5986 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
5987 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
5988 @end deffn
5989
5990 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
5991 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
5992 the flash clock.
5993 @end deffn
5994 @end deffn
5995
5996 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
5997 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
5998 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5999 @end deffn
6000
6001 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6002 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6003 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6004
6005 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6006
6007 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6008 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6009 @end deffn
6010
6011 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6012 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6013 @end deffn
6014
6015 @end deffn
6016
6017 @section NAND Flash Commands
6018 @cindex NAND
6019
6020 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6021 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6022 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6023
6024 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6025 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6026 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6027 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6028 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6029 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6030
6031 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6032 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6033 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6034 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6035 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6036 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6037 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6038 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6039 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6040 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6041
6042 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6043 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6044 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6045 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6046 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6047 every 512 bytes of data.
6048
6049 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6050 OpenOCD includes the apppropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6051 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6052 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6053 ECC mode is used.
6054
6055 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6056 @enumerate
6057 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6058 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6059 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6060 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6061 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6062 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6063 to access that device.
6064 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6065 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6066 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6067 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6068 de-brick a board.
6069 @end enumerate
6070
6071 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6072 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6073 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6074 are only 32 bits wide.
6075 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6076 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6077 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6078 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6079
6080 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6081 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6082 @cindex NAND configuration
6083
6084 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6085 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6086 OpenOCD has initialized.
6087
6088 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6089 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6090 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6091 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6092 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6093 they were a single (larger) device.
6094 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6095 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6096
6097 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6098 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6099 configuration files, not interactively.
6100
6101 @itemize @bullet
6102 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6103 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6104 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6105 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6106 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
6107 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
6108 commands to the NAND controller.
6109 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
6110 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
6111 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
6112 for more information.
6113 @end itemize
6114 @end deffn
6115
6116 @deffn Command {nand list}
6117 Prints a summary of each device declared
6118 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
6119 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
6120 @example
6121 > nand list
6122 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6123 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6124 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6125 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6126 >
6127 @end example
6128 @end deffn
6129
6130 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
6131 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
6132 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
6133 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6134 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
6135 it with most other NAND commands.
6136 @end deffn
6137
6138 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
6139
6140 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
6141 @cindex NAND reading
6142 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
6143 starting at the specified offset.
6144 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6145
6146 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6147 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6148
6149 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6150 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6151 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6152
6153 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6154 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6155 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6156 method which handled that error correction.
6157
6158 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6159 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6160 @itemize @bullet
6161 @item no oob_* parameter
6162 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6163 @item @code{oob_raw}
6164 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6165 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6166 spare areas associated with each data page.
6167 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6168 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6169 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6170 @item @code{oob_only}
6171 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6172 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6173 spare areas associated with each data page.
6174 @end itemize
6175 @end deffn
6176
6177 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
6178 @cindex NAND erasing
6179 @cindex NAND programming
6180 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
6181 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
6182 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6183 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6184 If those parameters are not specified,
6185 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
6186 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6187
6188 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
6189 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
6190 block marker.
6191 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
6192 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
6193 @end deffn
6194
6195 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
6196 @cindex NAND writing
6197 @cindex NAND programming
6198 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
6199 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
6200 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
6201 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6202
6203 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6204 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6205
6206 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6207 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
6208 past the end of the device.
6209 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
6210 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
6211 if that's being written.)
6212
6213 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
6214 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
6215 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
6216
6217 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
6218 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
6219 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
6220 @itemize @bullet
6221 @item no oob_* parameter
6222 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6223 If raw acccess is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
6224 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6225 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
6226 with hardware-computed ECC data.
6227 @item @code{oob_only}
6228 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
6229 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
6230 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
6231 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
6232 @item @code{oob_raw}
6233 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
6234 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
6235 un-altered OOB.
6236 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
6237 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
6238 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
6239 @item @code{oob_softecc}
6240 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6241 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
6242 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
6243 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6244 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6245 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
6246 @*File has only page data, which is written.
6247 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
6248 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
6249 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
6250 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
6251 @end itemize
6252 @end deffn
6253
6254 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
6255 @cindex NAND verification
6256 @cindex NAND programming
6257 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
6258 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
6259 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6260
6261 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6262 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6263
6264 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
6265 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
6266 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
6267 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
6268 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
6269
6270 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
6271 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
6272 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
6273
6274 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
6275 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
6276 hardward-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
6277 be removed in a future release.
6278 @end deffn
6279
6280 @subsection Other NAND commands
6281 @cindex NAND other commands
6282
6283 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
6284 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
6285 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
6286 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
6287 continues for @var{length} bytes.
6288 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
6289 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
6290 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6291
6292 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
6293 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
6294 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
6295 @end deffn
6296
6297 @deffn Command {nand info} num
6298 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6299 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
6300 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
6301 status for each block.
6302 @end deffn
6303
6304 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
6305 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
6306 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6307
6308 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
6309 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
6310 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
6311 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
6312 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
6313
6314 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
6315 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
6316 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
6317 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
6318 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
6319 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
6320 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
6321 @end deffn
6322
6323 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
6324 @subsection NAND Driver List
6325 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
6326 driver-specific options and behaviors.
6327 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
6328
6329 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
6330 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
6331 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
6332 address of the ECC controller.
6333 @example
6334 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
6335 @end example
6336 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
6337 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
6338 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
6339 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
6340 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
6341 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
6342 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
6343 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6344 @end deffn
6345 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
6346 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
6347 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6348 @end deffn
6349
6350 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
6351 properly configured for input or output.
6352 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
6353 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
6354 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6355 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6356 @end deffn
6357 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
6358 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
6359 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
6360 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
6361 @end deffn
6362 @end deffn
6363
6364 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
6365 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
6366 chips from Texas Instruments.
6367 It takes three extra parameters:
6368 address of the NAND chip;
6369 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
6370 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
6371 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
6372 @example
6373 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
6374 @end example
6375 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
6376 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
6377 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
6378 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
6379 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
6380 @end deffn
6381
6382 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
6383 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6384 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
6385 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
6386 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
6387 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
6388 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6389 @end deffn
6390
6391 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
6392 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
6393 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
6394 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
6395 @end deffn
6396 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
6397
6398 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
6399 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
6400 should work for this chip aswell.
6401 @end deffn
6402
6403 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
6404 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
6405 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
6406 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
6407 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
6408 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
6409 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
6410 @example
6411 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
6412 @end example
6413 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
6414 Turns on/off bad block information swaping from main area,
6415 without parameter query status.
6416 @end deffn
6417 @end deffn
6418
6419 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
6420 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
6421 parameter: the address of the controller.
6422 @example
6423 nand device orion 0xd8000000
6424 @end example
6425 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
6426 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6427 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6428 change any behavior.
6429 @end deffn
6430
6431 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
6432 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
6433 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
6434 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
6435 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
6436 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
6437 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
6438 specialized commands.
6439 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
6440 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
6441 change any behavior.
6442 @end deffn
6443
6444 @section mFlash
6445
6446 @subsection mFlash Configuration
6447 @cindex mFlash Configuration
6448
6449 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
6450 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
6451 address @var{base}.
6452 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
6453 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
6454
6455 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
6456
6457 @example
6458 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
6459 @end example
6460
6461 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
6462
6463 @example
6464 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
6465 @end example
6466 @end deffn
6467
6468 @subsection mFlash commands
6469 @cindex mFlash commands
6470
6471 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
6472 Configure mflash PLL.
6473 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
6474 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
6475 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
6476 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
6477 @end deffn
6478
6479 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
6480 Configure bootable option.
6481 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
6482 (4kB) for boot.
6483 @end deffn
6484
6485 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
6486 Configure storage information.
6487 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
6488 written.
6489 @end deffn
6490
6491 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
6492 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
6493 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
6494 @end deffn
6495
6496 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
6497 Probe mflash.
6498 @end deffn
6499
6500 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
6501 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
6502 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
6503 @end deffn
6504
6505 @node Flash Programming
6506 @chapter Flash Programming
6507
6508 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
6509 Programming can be acheived by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
6510 or using the cmds given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
6511
6512 @*To simplify using the flash cmds directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
6513 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
6514
6515 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be peformed.
6516 @enumerate
6517 @item 'init' is executed.
6518 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
6519 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
6520 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
6521 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
6522 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
6523 @end enumerate
6524
6525 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
6526
6527 @example
6528 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
6529 # are optional parameters
6530 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6531 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
6532
6533 # binary files need the flash address passing
6534 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
6535 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
6536 @end example
6537
6538 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
6539 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
6540 @cindex PLD
6541 @cindex FPGA
6542
6543 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
6544 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
6545 OpenOCD can support programming them.
6546 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
6547 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
6548 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
6549 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
6550
6551 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
6552
6553 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
6554 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
6555 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
6556
6557 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
6558 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
6559
6560 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
6561 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
6562 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
6563 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
6564 behavior.
6565 @end deffn
6566
6567 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
6568 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
6569 @end deffn
6570
6571 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
6572 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
6573 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
6574 @end deffn
6575
6576 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
6577
6578 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
6579 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
6580 that particular type of PLD.
6581
6582 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
6583 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
6584 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
6585
6586 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
6587 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
6588 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
6589
6590 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
6591 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
6592 for FPGA @var{num}.
6593 @end deffn
6594 @end deffn
6595
6596 @node General Commands
6597 @chapter General Commands
6598 @cindex commands
6599
6600 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
6601 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
6602 commands are documented elsewhere.
6603
6604 Intent:
6605 @itemize @bullet
6606 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
6607 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
6608 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programatically,
6609 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
6610
6611 @item @b{From the human}
6612 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
6613 or via GDB (default port 3333).
6614
6615 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
6616 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
6617 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
6618
6619 @item @b{Machine Interface}
6620 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
6621 port is 5555.
6622 @end itemize
6623
6624
6625 @section Server Commands
6626
6627 @deffn {Command} exit
6628 Exits the current telnet session.
6629 @end deffn
6630
6631 @deffn {Command} help [string]
6632 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
6633 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
6634 Not every command provides helptext.
6635
6636 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
6637 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
6638 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
6639 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
6640 @end deffn
6641
6642 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
6643 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
6644 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
6645 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
6646 Useful in connection with script files
6647 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
6648 @end deffn
6649
6650 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
6651 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
6652 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
6653 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
6654 @end deffn
6655
6656 @anchor{debuglevel}
6657 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
6658 @cindex message level
6659 Display debug level.
6660 If @var{n} (from 0..3) is provided, then set it to that level.
6661 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
6662 Level 0 is error messages only;
6663 level 1 adds warnings;
6664 level 2 adds informational messages;
6665 and level 3 adds debugging messages.
6666 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
6667 the command line along with the location of that log
6668 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
6669 @xref{Running}.
6670 @end deffn
6671
6672 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
6673 Logs a message at "user" priority.
6674 Output @var{message} to stdout.
6675 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
6676 @example
6677 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
6678 @end example
6679 @end deffn
6680
6681 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
6682 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
6683 the initial log output channel is stderr.
6684 @end deffn
6685
6686 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
6687 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
6688 @end deffn
6689
6690 @deffn Command bindto [name]
6691 Specify address by name on which to listen for incoming TCP/IP connections.
6692 By default, OpenOCD will listen on all available interfaces.
6693 @end deffn
6694
6695 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
6696 @section Target State handling
6697 @cindex reset
6698 @cindex halt
6699 @cindex target initialization
6700
6701 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
6702 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
6703 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
6704 a current target which is used to perform the
6705 various operations. The current target may be changed
6706 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
6707 target which should become current.
6708
6709 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
6710 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
6711 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
6712 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
6713 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
6714
6715 @emph{With no arguments}:
6716 list all available registers for the current target,
6717 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
6718 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
6719 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
6720 are flagged as such.
6721
6722 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
6723 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
6724 bypassing any internal cache.
6725
6726 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
6727 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
6728 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
6729 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
6730 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
6731 relevant module will flush such values.
6732
6733 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
6734 Debug and trace infrastructure:
6735
6736 @example
6737 > reg
6738 ===== ARM registers
6739 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
6740 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
6741 (2) r2 (/32)
6742 ...
6743 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
6744 >
6745 @end example
6746 @end deffn
6747
6748 @deffn Command halt [ms]
6749 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
6750 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
6751 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
6752 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
6753 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
6754 (and enter debug mode).
6755 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
6756
6757 @quotation Warning
6758 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
6759 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
6760 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
6761 power mode by gating the core clock;
6762 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
6763
6764 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
6765 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
6766 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
6767 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
6768 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
6769 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
6770
6771 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
6772 work with a JTAG debugger.
6773 Tasking environments generaly have idle loops where the body is the
6774 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
6775 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
6776 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
6777 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
6778 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
6779 @end quotation
6780
6781 @end deffn
6782
6783 @deffn Command resume [address]
6784 Resume the target at its current code position,
6785 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6786 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
6787 @end deffn
6788
6789 @deffn Command step [address]
6790 Single-step the target at its current code position,
6791 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
6792 @end deffn
6793
6794 @anchor{resetcommand}
6795 @deffn Command reset
6796 @deffnx Command {reset run}
6797 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
6798 @deffnx Command {reset init}
6799 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
6800 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
6801 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
6802
6803 The optional parameter specifies what should
6804 happen after the reset.
6805 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
6806 The other options will not work on all systems.
6807 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
6808
6809 @itemize @minus
6810 @item @b{run} Let the target run
6811 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
6812 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
6813 @end itemize
6814 @end deffn
6815
6816 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
6817 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
6818 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
6819 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
6820 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
6821 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
6822 state.
6823 @end deffn
6824
6825 @section I/O Utilities
6826
6827 These commands are available when
6828 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
6829 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
6830 notably the ZY1000.
6831 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
6832
6833 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
6834
6835 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
6836 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
6837 the text file @file{filename}.
6838 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
6839 The last string is followed by a newline.
6840 @end deffn
6841
6842 @deffn Command cat filename
6843 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
6844 @end deffn
6845
6846 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
6847 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
6848 into @file{dest_filename}.
6849 @end deffn
6850
6851 @deffn Command ip
6852 @emph{No description provided.}
6853 @end deffn
6854
6855 @deffn Command ls
6856 @emph{No description provided.}
6857 @end deffn
6858
6859 @deffn Command mac
6860 @emph{No description provided.}
6861 @end deffn
6862
6863 @deffn Command meminfo
6864 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
6865 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
6866 @end deffn
6867
6868 @deffn Command peek
6869 @emph{No description provided.}
6870 @end deffn
6871
6872 @deffn Command poke
6873 @emph{No description provided.}
6874 @end deffn
6875
6876 @deffn Command rm filename
6877 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
6878 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
6879 @end deffn
6880
6881 @deffn Command trunc filename
6882 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
6883 @end deffn
6884
6885 @anchor{memoryaccess}
6886 @section Memory access commands
6887 @cindex memory access
6888
6889 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
6890 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
6891 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
6892 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
6893
6894 @enumerate
6895 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
6896 to change the current target.
6897 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
6898 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
6899 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
6900 @end enumerate
6901
6902 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
6903 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
6904 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
6905 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
6906 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
6907 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
6908 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6909 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6910 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6911 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6912 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
6913 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
6914 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
6915 @end deffn
6916
6917 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
6918 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
6919 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
6920 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
6921 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
6922 at the specified address @var{addr}.
6923 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
6924 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
6925 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
6926 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
6927 @end deffn
6928
6929 @anchor{imageaccess}
6930 @section Image loading commands
6931 @cindex image loading
6932 @cindex image dumping
6933
6934 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
6935 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
6936 binary file named @var{filename}.
6937 @end deffn
6938
6939 @deffn Command {fast_load}
6940 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
6941 current target. Must be preceeded by fast_load_image.
6942 @end deffn
6943
6944 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
6945 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
6946 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
6947 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
6948 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
6949 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
6950 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
6951 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
6952 separately.
6953 @end deffn
6954
6955 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
6956 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
6957 The file format may optionally be specified
6958 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
6959 In addition the following arguments may be specifed:
6960 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
6961 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
6962 @example
6963 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
6964 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
6965 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
6966 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
6967 $address $length
6968 @}
6969 @end example
6970 @end deffn
6971
6972 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
6973 Displays image section sizes and addresses
6974 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
6975 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
6976 The file format may optionally be specified
6977 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6978 @end deffn
6979
6980 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
6981 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
6982 The file format may optionally be specified
6983 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
6984 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
6985 @end deffn
6986
6987
6988 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
6989 @cindex breakpoint
6990 @cindex watchpoint
6991
6992 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
6993 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
6994 watchpoints.
6995 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
6996
6997 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
6998 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
6999 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7000 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7001 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7002 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7003
7004 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7005 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7006 @end deffn
7007
7008 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7009 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7010 @end deffn
7011
7012 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7013 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7014 @end deffn
7015
7016 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7017 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7018 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7019 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7020 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7021 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7022 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7023 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7024 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7025 @end deffn
7026
7027 @section Misc Commands
7028
7029 @cindex profiling
7030 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7031 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7032 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7033 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7034 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7035 limit the address range.
7036 @end deffn
7037
7038 @deffn Command {version}
7039 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7040 @end deffn
7041
7042 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7043 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7044 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7045 @end deffn
7046
7047 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7048 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7049 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7050 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7051
7052 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7053 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7054 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7055 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7056
7057 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7058 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7059 @cindex tracing
7060 @cindex ETM
7061 @cindex ETB
7062
7063 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7064 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7065 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7066
7067 @itemize
7068 @item
7069 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7070 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7071 supports such an interface.
7072 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7073 and trace port support.)
7074 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7075 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7076 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7077 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7078 in the board-specific configuration file.
7079 @item
7080 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
7081 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
7082 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
7083 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
7084 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
7085 @end itemize
7086
7087 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
7088
7089 @quotation Issues
7090 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
7091 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
7092
7093 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
7094 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
7095 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
7096 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
7097 dummy trace port driver}.
7098
7099 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
7100 as well as tracing only during specific states
7101 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
7102
7103 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
7104 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
7105 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
7106 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
7107 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
7108
7109 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
7110 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
7111 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
7112 this original style of JTAG access.
7113 @end quotation
7114
7115 @subsection ETM Configuration
7116 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
7117
7118 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
7119 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
7120 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
7121
7122 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
7123 which are a function of silicon capabilties (exposed later
7124 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
7125 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
7126 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
7127 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
7128 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
7129 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
7130 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
7131
7132 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
7133 or @option{demultiplexed}.
7134 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
7135
7136 @quotation Warning
7137 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
7138 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
7139 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
7140 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
7141 @end quotation
7142
7143 @quotation Note
7144 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
7145 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
7146 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
7147 what CPU activities are traced.
7148 @end quotation
7149 @end deffn
7150
7151 @deffn Command {etm info}
7152 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
7153 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
7154 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
7155 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
7156 @end deffn
7157
7158 @deffn Command {etm status}
7159 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
7160 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
7161 Did trace data overflow?
7162 Was it triggered?
7163 @end deffn
7164
7165 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
7166 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
7167 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
7168 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
7169 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
7170
7171 @itemize
7172 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
7173 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
7174 The value is one of
7175 @option{none} (save nothing),
7176 @option{data} (save data),
7177 @option{address} (save addresses),
7178 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
7179 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
7180 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
7181 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
7182 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
7183 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
7184 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
7185 trace stream without an image of the code.
7186 @end itemize
7187 @end deffn
7188
7189 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7190 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
7191 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
7192 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
7193 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
7194
7195 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
7196 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
7197 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
7198 @end deffn
7199
7200 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
7201
7202 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
7203 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
7204 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
7205
7206 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
7207 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
7208 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
7209 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
7210 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
7211 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
7212 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
7213
7214 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
7215
7216 @itemize
7217 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
7218 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
7219 for instruction access within that function's body.
7220 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
7221 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
7222 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
7223 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
7224 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
7225 combining one of the above models with a counter.
7226 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
7227 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
7228 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
7229 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
7230 @item @emph{... more}
7231 @end itemize
7232
7233 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
7234 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
7235
7236 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
7237 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
7238 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
7239 @end deffn
7240
7241 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
7242 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
7243 @end deffn
7244
7245 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
7246 Opens an image file.
7247 @end deffn
7248
7249 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
7250 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
7251 @end deffn
7252
7253 @deffn Command {etm start}
7254 Starts trace data collection.
7255 @end deffn
7256
7257 @deffn Command {etm stop}
7258 Stops trace data collection.
7259 @end deffn
7260
7261 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
7262 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
7263
7264 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
7265
7266 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
7267 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7268 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
7269 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
7270 any trace data collection.}
7271 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
7272 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
7273 @end deffn
7274 @end deffn
7275
7276 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
7277 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
7278 to use on-chip ETB memory.
7279 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
7280 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
7281 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
7282 @end deffn
7283 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
7284 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
7285 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
7286 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
7287 trace trigger becomes active.
7288
7289 @itemize
7290 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
7291 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
7292 afterwards.
7293 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
7294 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
7295 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
7296 what caused that event to happen.
7297 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
7298 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
7299 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
7300 how the event caused trouble.
7301 @end itemize
7302 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
7303 @end deffn
7304
7305 @end deffn
7306
7307 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
7308 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
7309 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
7310 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
7311 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
7312
7313 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
7314 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
7315
7316 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
7317 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
7318 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
7319 @end deffn
7320
7321 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
7322 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
7323 @end deffn
7324
7325 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
7326 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
7327 @end deffn
7328 @end deffn
7329
7330
7331 @section Generic ARM
7332 @cindex ARM
7333
7334 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
7335 They are available in addition to other core-specific
7336 commands that may be available.
7337
7338 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
7339 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
7340 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
7341 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
7342 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7343 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
7344 @end deffn
7345
7346 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
7347 @cindex disassemble
7348 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
7349 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
7350 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
7351 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
7352 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
7353 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
7354 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
7355
7356 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
7357 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
7358 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
7359 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
7360 with a handful of exceptions.
7361 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
7362 @end deffn
7363
7364 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
7365 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
7366 passing parameters @var{CRn},
7367 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7368 and using the MCR instruction.
7369 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7370 an ARM register.)
7371 @end deffn
7372
7373 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
7374 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
7375 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
7376 and the MRC instruction.
7377 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
7378 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
7379 an ARM register.)
7380 @end deffn
7381
7382 @deffn Command {arm reg}
7383 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
7384 core mode if necessary.
7385 @end deffn
7386
7387 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7388 @cindex ARM semihosting
7389 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
7390
7391 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
7392 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
7393 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
7394 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
7395 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
7396 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
7397 @end deffn
7398
7399 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
7400 @cindex ARMv4
7401 @cindex ARMv5
7402
7403 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
7404 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
7405 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
7406 variant.
7407
7408 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
7409 @cindex ARM7
7410 @cindex ARM9
7411
7412 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
7413 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
7414 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
7415 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
7416
7417 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7418 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
7419 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
7420 instead of breakpoints.
7421 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7422
7423 This should be
7424 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
7425 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
7426 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
7427 @end deffn
7428
7429 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7430 @cindex DCC
7431 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
7432 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
7433 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7434
7435 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
7436 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
7437 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
7438 @end deffn
7439
7440 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7441 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
7442 that don't check completion of the operation.
7443 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7444
7445 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
7446 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
7447 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
7448 @end deffn
7449
7450 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
7451 @cindex ARM720T
7452
7453 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
7454 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7455 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
7456 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
7457
7458 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
7459 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7460 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7461
7462 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
7463 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7464 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
7465 @end deffn
7466
7467 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
7468 @cindex ARM9
7469
7470 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
7471 integer processors.
7472 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
7473
7474 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
7475 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
7476 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
7477 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
7478
7479 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
7480 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7481 @cindex vector_catch
7482 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
7483 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
7484 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
7485 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
7486 to those hardware vectors.
7487
7488 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
7489 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
7490 vector catch hardware to intercept
7491 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
7492 @option{none} of them,
7493 or a list with one or more of the following:
7494 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
7495 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
7496 @end deffn
7497
7498 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
7499 @cindex ARM920T
7500
7501 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
7502 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
7503 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
7504 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7505 and ARM9 commands.
7506
7507 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
7508 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
7509 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
7510 @end deffn
7511
7512 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
7513 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7514 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7515 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
7516 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
7517 (Not all registers can be written.)
7518 @end deffn
7519
7520 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
7521 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
7522 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
7523
7524 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
7525 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
7526 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
7527 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
7528 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
7529 or using zero if no other address is provided.
7530 @end deffn
7531
7532 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
7533 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
7534 @end deffn
7535
7536 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
7537 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
7538 @end deffn
7539
7540 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
7541 @cindex ARM926ej-s
7542
7543 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
7544 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
7545 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
7546 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7547 and ARM9 commands.
7548
7549 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
7550 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
7551
7552 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
7553 Print information about the caches found.
7554 @end deffn
7555
7556 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
7557 @cindex ARM966E
7558
7559 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
7560 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7561 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
7562 and ARM9 commands.
7563
7564 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
7565 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7566 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7567 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
7568 ARM966E-S TRM.
7569 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
7570 as required for BIST support.
7571 @end deffn
7572
7573 @subsection XScale specific commands
7574 @cindex XScale
7575
7576 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
7577
7578 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
7579 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
7580 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
7581 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
7582 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
7583 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
7584 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
7585
7586 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
7587 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicity write
7588 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
7589 the mini-IC.
7590
7591 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
7592 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
7593 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
7594 code layout in memory:
7595 @example
7596 _vectors:
7597 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7598 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7599 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7600 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7601 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7602 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7603 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7604 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
7605 .org 0x100
7606 .long real_reset_vector
7607 .long real_ui_handler
7608 .long real_swi_handler
7609 .long real_pf_abort
7610 .long real_data_abort
7611 .long 0 /* unused */
7612 .long real_irq_handler
7613 .long real_fiq_handler
7614 @end example
7615
7616 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
7617 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
7618 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
7619 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
7620 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
7621 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
7622 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
7623 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
7624 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
7625 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
7626 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
7627 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
7628 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
7629 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
7630 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
7631 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
7632 software.
7633
7634 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
7635 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
7636 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
7637 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
7638
7639 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
7640 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
7641 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
7642 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
7643 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
7644 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
7645 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
7646 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
7647 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
7648
7649 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
7650 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
7651
7652 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
7653 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
7654 @end deffn
7655
7656 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
7657 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
7658 @end deffn
7659
7660 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
7661 Displays information about the CPU caches.
7662 @end deffn
7663
7664 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
7665 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
7666 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
7667 @end deffn
7668
7669 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
7670 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
7671 @end deffn
7672
7673 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7674 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
7675 @end deffn
7676
7677 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
7678 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
7679 @end deffn
7680
7681 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7682 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
7683 @end deffn
7684
7685 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7686 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
7687 @end deffn
7688
7689 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
7690 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
7691 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
7692 and modifying how it is emptied.
7693 @end deffn
7694
7695 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
7696 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
7697 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
7698 The image @var{type} may be one of
7699 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
7700 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
7701 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
7702 @end deffn
7703
7704 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
7705 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
7706 @cindex vector_catch
7707 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
7708 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
7709
7710 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
7711 @example
7712 0x01 Trap Reset
7713 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
7714 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
7715 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
7716 0x10 Trap Data Abort
7717 0x20 reserved
7718 0x40 Trap IRQ
7719 0x80 Trap FIQ
7720 @end example
7721 @end deffn
7722
7723 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
7724 @cindex vector_table
7725
7726 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
7727 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
7728 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
7729 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
7730 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
7731
7732 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
7733
7734 @end deffn
7735
7736 @section ARMv6 Architecture
7737 @cindex ARMv6
7738
7739 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
7740 @cindex ARM11
7741
7742 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7743 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
7744 which is enabled by default.
7745 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7746 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
7747 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
7748 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
7749 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
7750 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
7751 @end deffn
7752
7753 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7754 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
7755 which is enabled by default.
7756 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
7757 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
7758 @end deffn
7759
7760 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
7761 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
7762 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
7763 they are disabled by default.
7764 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
7765 @end deffn
7766
7767 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
7768 @cindex vector_catch
7769 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
7770 coprocessor 14 register 7.
7771 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7772
7773 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
7774 for certain hardware events.
7775 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
7776 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
7777 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
7778 @end deffn
7779
7780 @section ARMv7 Architecture
7781 @cindex ARMv7
7782
7783 @subsection ARMv7 Debug Access Port (DAP) specific commands
7784 @cindex Debug Access Port
7785 @cindex DAP
7786 These commands are specific to ARM architecture v7 Debug Access Port (DAP),
7787 included on Cortex-M and Cortex-A systems.
7788 They are available in addition to other core-specific commands that may be available.
7789
7790 @deffn Command {dap apid} [num]
7791 Displays ID register from AP @var{num},
7792 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7793 @end deffn
7794
7795 @deffn Command {dap apreg} ap_num reg [value]
7796 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
7797 or set a new value @var{value}.
7798 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
7799 @end deffn
7800
7801 @deffn Command {dap apsel} [num]
7802 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
7803 @end deffn
7804
7805 @deffn Command {dap baseaddr} [num]
7806 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
7807 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7808 @end deffn
7809
7810 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
7811 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
7812 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
7813 @end deffn
7814
7815 @deffn Command {dap memaccess} [value]
7816 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
7817 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
7818 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
7819 @end deffn
7820
7821 @deffn Command {dap apcsw} [0 / 1]
7822 fix CSW_SPROT from register AP_REG_CSW on selected dap.
7823 Defaulting to 0.
7824 @end deffn
7825
7826 @deffn Command {dap ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
7827 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
7828 Disabled by default
7829 @end deffn
7830
7831
7832 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
7833 @cindex Cortex-A
7834
7835 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
7836 display information about target caches
7837 @end deffn
7838
7839 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
7840 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
7841 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
7842 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
7843 Defaults to 'off'.
7844 @end deffn
7845
7846 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
7847 Initialize core debug
7848 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7849 @end deffn
7850
7851 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
7852 Disable SMP mode
7853 @end deffn
7854
7855 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
7856 Enable SMP mode
7857 @end deffn
7858
7859 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
7860 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
7861 @end deffn
7862
7863 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7864 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7865 @end deffn
7866
7867 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
7868 configure l2x cache
7869 @end deffn
7870
7871
7872 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
7873 @cindex Cortex-R
7874
7875 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
7876 Initialize core debug
7877 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
7878 @end deffn
7879
7880 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
7881 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
7882 @end deffn
7883
7884
7885 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
7886 @cindex tracing
7887 @cindex SWO
7888 @cindex SWV
7889 @cindex TPIU
7890 @cindex ITM
7891 @cindex ETM
7892
7893 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
7894 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
7895 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
7896
7897 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
7898 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
7899 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
7900 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
7901
7902 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
7903 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
7904 debugger adapter features.
7905
7906 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
7907 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
7908
7909 Command options:
7910 @itemize @minus
7911 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
7912 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
7913 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
7914 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7915 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
7916 either a regular file or a named pipe);
7917 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
7918 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
7919 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
7920 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
7921 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
7922 coding;
7923 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
7924 regular UART 8N1) coding;
7925 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
7926 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
7927 data is to be output via SWO;
7928 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
7929 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
7930 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
7931 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
7932 rate automatically.
7933 @end itemize
7934
7935 Example usage:
7936 @enumerate
7937 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
7938 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
7939 enough to:
7940 @example
7941 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
7942 ...
7943 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
7944 ...
7945 @end example
7946 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
7947 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
7948 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
7949 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
7950 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
7951 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
7952 @example
7953 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
7954 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
7955 @end example
7956 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
7957 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
7958 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
7959 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
7960 @example
7961 openocd -f interface/stlink-v2-1.cfg \
7962 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
7963 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
7964 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
7965 @end example
7966 @end enumerate
7967 @end deffn
7968
7969 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7970 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
7971 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
7972 @end deffn
7973
7974 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7975 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
7976 @end deffn
7977
7978 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
7979 @cindex Cortex-M
7980
7981 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
7982 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
7983
7984 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping a way they get
7985 served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
7986 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
7987 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
7988 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
7989 the step command leaves with the core running.
7990
7991 Note that a free breakpoint is required for the @option{auto} option. If no
7992 breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step is taken
7993 with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option does.
7994
7995 Default is @option{auto}.
7996 @end deffn
7997
7998 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
7999 @cindex vector_catch
8000 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8001 for certain hardware events.
8002
8003 Parameters request interception of
8004 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8005 @option{none} of them,
8006 or one or more of the following:
8007 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8008 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8009 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8010 @option{irq_err},
8011 @option{state_err},
8012 @option{chk_err}, or
8013 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
8014 @option{reset}.
8015 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
8016 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
8017 are mapped to HardFault.
8018 UsageFault checks for
8019 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
8020 must also be explicitly enabled.
8021
8022 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
8023 @end deffn
8024
8025 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
8026 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
8027 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8028 @itemize @minus
8029 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8030 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
8031 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
8032 @end itemize
8033 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
8034 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
8035 are uneffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
8036 the peripherals.
8037 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
8038 @end deffn
8039
8040 @section Intel Architecture
8041
8042 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
8043 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
8044 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
8045 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
8046 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
8047 @itemize
8048 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
8049 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
8050 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
8051 @end itemize
8052
8053 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
8054 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
8055 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
8056
8057 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
8058 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8059 @end deffn
8060
8061 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
8062 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8063 @end deffn
8064
8065 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
8066 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8067 @end deffn
8068
8069 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
8070 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8071 @end deffn
8072
8073 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
8074 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8075 @end deffn
8076
8077 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
8078 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
8079 @end deffn
8080
8081 @section OpenRISC Architecture
8082
8083 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
8084 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
8085
8086 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
8087 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
8088 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
8089 @end deffn
8090 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
8091 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
8092
8093 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
8094
8095 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
8096 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
8097 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
8098 @end deffn
8099
8100 @subsection Registers commands
8101 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
8102 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
8103 included in the generated target descriptor file.
8104
8105 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
8106
8107 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
8108 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
8109 and "timer" groups.
8110
8111 @emph{example:}
8112 @example
8113 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
8114 @end example
8115
8116
8117 @end deffn
8118 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
8119 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
8120
8121 @emph{group} can be "system",
8122 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
8123 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
8124 @end deffn
8125
8126 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
8127 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
8128 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
8129 @cindex tracing
8130 @cindex libdcc
8131 @cindex DCC
8132 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
8133 the target uses appropriate libraries.
8134 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
8135 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
8136
8137 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
8138 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
8139 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
8140 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
8141 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
8142 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
8143
8144 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
8145 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
8146 arrays of various size integers from the target,
8147 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
8148 The target being debugged may
8149 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
8150 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
8151 each supported by a command:
8152
8153 @itemize
8154 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
8155 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
8156 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
8157 finding out how some fault was triggered.
8158
8159 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
8160 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
8161 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
8162
8163 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
8164 and then displayed at any time.
8165 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
8166
8167 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
8168 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
8169 @end itemize
8170
8171 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
8172 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
8173 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
8174 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
8175 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
8176 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
8177 does the same thing.
8178
8179 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
8180 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
8181 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
8182 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
8183 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
8184
8185 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
8186 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
8187 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
8188 @end deffn
8189
8190 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
8191 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
8192 in the order they triggered.
8193 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
8194 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
8195 history records.
8196 @end deffn
8197
8198 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
8199 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
8200 they have been triggered.
8201 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
8202 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
8203 and associates it with that identifier.
8204
8205 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
8206 are not related except by this command.
8207 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
8208 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
8209 @end deffn
8210
8211
8212 @node JTAG Commands
8213 @chapter JTAG Commands
8214 @cindex JTAG Commands
8215 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
8216 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
8217 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
8218 may be needed to work with targets which require special
8219 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
8220
8221 To use these commands you will need to understand some
8222 of the basics of JTAG, including:
8223
8224 @itemize @bullet
8225 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
8226 devices such as a CPUs.
8227 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
8228 standard state machine (in parallel)
8229 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
8230 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
8231 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
8232 while the reading previous ones.
8233 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
8234 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
8235 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
8236 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
8237 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
8238 registers.
8239 @end itemize
8240
8241 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
8242
8243 These commands are used by developers who need to access
8244 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
8245 the order of TAP state transitions.
8246 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
8247 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
8248 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
8249 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
8250 these commands are not available.
8251
8252 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8253 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
8254 that specify the entire register.
8255 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
8256 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
8257 The return value holds the original value of each
8258 of those fields.
8259
8260 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
8261 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
8262 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
8263 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
8264 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
8265
8266 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
8267 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
8268
8269 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8270 in that state.
8271 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
8272 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8273 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8274
8275 @quotation Warning
8276 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
8277 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
8278 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
8279 data registers, which may have different lengths.
8280 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
8281 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
8282 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
8283 (by connecting a different scan chain).
8284 @end quotation
8285 @end deffn
8286
8287 @deffn Command {flush_count}
8288 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
8289 This may be used for performance tuning.
8290
8291 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
8292 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
8293 not change with the amount of data which is written.
8294 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
8295 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
8296 instead of batching them into larger operations.
8297 @end deffn
8298
8299 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
8300 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
8301 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
8302 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
8303 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
8304 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
8305
8306 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
8307 in that state.
8308 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
8309 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
8310 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
8311
8312 @quotation Note
8313 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
8314 register values, unlike data register values.
8315 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
8316 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
8317 @end quotation
8318 @end deffn
8319
8320 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
8321 Set values of reset signals.
8322 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
8323 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
8324 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
8325 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8326 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
8327 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8328 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8329
8330 Note that TRST is specially handled.
8331 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8332 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8333 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8334 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8335 instead of the TRST signal.
8336 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8337 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8338 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8339 with handlers for that event.
8340 @end deffn
8341
8342 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
8343 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
8344 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
8345 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
8346 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
8347 Then, in a series of single state transitions
8348 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
8349 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
8350 The final state must also be stable.
8351 @end deffn
8352
8353 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
8354 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
8355 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
8356 Instructions often need some time
8357 to execute before they take effect.
8358 @end deffn
8359
8360 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
8361 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
8362
8363 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8364 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
8365 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
8366 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
8367 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
8368 @end deffn
8369
8370 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8371 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
8372 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
8373 must also be enabled.
8374 Default is enabled.
8375 @end deffn
8376
8377 @section TAP state names
8378 @cindex TAP state names
8379
8380 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
8381 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
8382 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
8383 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
8384
8385 @itemize @bullet
8386 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
8387 acts as if TRST were pulsed
8388 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
8389 @item @b{DRSELECT}
8390 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
8391 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8392 through the data register
8393 @item @b{DREXIT1}
8394 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
8395 for update or more shifting
8396 @item @b{DREXIT2}
8397 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
8398 @item @b{IRSELECT}
8399 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
8400 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
8401 through the instruction register
8402 @item @b{IREXIT1}
8403 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
8404 for update or more shifting
8405 @item @b{IREXIT2}
8406 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
8407 @end itemize
8408
8409 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
8410 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
8411 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
8412 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
8413
8414 @itemize @bullet
8415 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
8416 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
8417 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
8418 may not be as expected.
8419 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
8420 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
8421 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
8422 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
8423 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
8424 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
8425 @end itemize
8426
8427 @node Boundary Scan Commands
8428 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
8429
8430 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
8431 boundary scan based hardware testing.
8432 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
8433 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
8434
8435 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
8436 @cindex Serial Vector Format
8437 @cindex SVF
8438
8439 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
8440 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
8441 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8442 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8443
8444 @deffn Command {svf} filename [@option{quiet}]
8445 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8446 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
8447 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8448 each command is logged before it is executed.
8449 @end deffn
8450
8451 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8452 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
8453 @cindex XSVF
8454
8455 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
8456 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
8457 Xilinx devices.
8458 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
8459 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
8460
8461 @quotation Important
8462 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
8463 @end quotation
8464
8465 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
8466 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
8467 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
8468 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
8469 that TAP.
8470 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
8471 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
8472 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
8473 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
8474 @end deffn
8475
8476 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
8477 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
8478 after building the software.
8479 You may find them useful:
8480
8481 @itemize
8482 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
8483 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
8484 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
8485 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
8486 @end itemize
8487
8488 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
8489 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
8490 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
8491 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
8492 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
8493 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
8494 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
8495
8496
8497 @node Utility Commands
8498 @chapter Utility Commands
8499 @cindex Utility Commands
8500
8501 @section RAM testing
8502 @cindex RAM testing
8503
8504 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
8505 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
8506 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
8507 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
8508 hardware problems.
8509
8510 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
8511 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
8512 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
8513 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
8514
8515 Load the memory testing functions with
8516
8517 @example
8518 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
8519 @end example
8520
8521 to get access to the following facilities:
8522
8523 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
8524 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
8525 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
8526 @end deffn
8527
8528 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
8529 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
8530 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
8531 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
8532 @end deffn
8533
8534 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
8535 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
8536 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
8537 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
8538 @end deffn
8539
8540 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
8541 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
8542 @end deffn
8543
8544 @section Firmware recovery helpers
8545 @cindex Firmware recovery
8546
8547 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
8548 devices recovery with JTAG.
8549
8550 For quickstart instructions run:
8551 @example
8552 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
8553 @end example
8554
8555 @node TFTP
8556 @chapter TFTP
8557 @cindex TFTP
8558 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
8559 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
8560
8561 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
8562 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
8563 server (tftpd). For example,
8564
8565 @example
8566 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
8567 @end example
8568
8569 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
8570 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
8571
8572 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
8573 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
8574 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
8575 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
8576
8577 @node GDB and OpenOCD
8578 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
8579 @cindex GDB
8580 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
8581 to debug remote targets.
8582 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
8583
8584 @itemize
8585 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
8586 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
8587 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
8588 as shown in this chapter.
8589 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
8590 that also will probably need to be configured.
8591 @end itemize
8592
8593 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
8594 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
8595 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
8596 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
8597 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
8598 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
8599
8600 @section Connecting to GDB
8601 @cindex Connecting to GDB
8602 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
8603 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
8604 errors, which has since been fixed; see
8605 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
8606
8607 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
8608
8609 @enumerate
8610 @item
8611 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
8612 @example
8613 target remote localhost:3333
8614 @end example
8615 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
8616
8617 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
8618 @example
8619 target extended-remote localhost:3333
8620 @end example
8621 @item
8622 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
8623 @example
8624 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
8625 @end example
8626 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
8627 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
8628 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
8629 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
8630 @end enumerate
8631
8632 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
8633 GDB command line.
8634
8635 @section Sample GDB session startup
8636
8637 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
8638 than they do when you're debugging locally.
8639 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
8640 small ARM program.
8641 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
8642 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
8643
8644 @example
8645 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
8646 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
8647 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
8648 ...
8649 (gdb) monitor reset halt
8650 ...
8651 (gdb) load
8652 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
8653 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
8654 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
8655 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
8656 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
8657 (gdb) continue
8658 Continuing.
8659 ...
8660 @end example
8661
8662 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
8663 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
8664 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
8665 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
8666
8667 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
8668
8669 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
8670 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
8671 packet size and the device's memory map.
8672 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
8673 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
8674 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
8675
8676 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
8677 You may need to set those up by hand.
8678 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
8679 something like:
8680
8681 @example
8682 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
8683 @end example
8684
8685 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
8686
8687 @example
8688 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
8689 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
8690 @end example
8691
8692 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
8693 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
8694 do not have such restrictions.
8695
8696 Another example of useful GDB configuration came from a user who
8697 found that single stepping his Cortex-M3 didn't work well with IRQs
8698 and an RTOS until he told GDB to disable the IRQs while stepping:
8699
8700 @example
8701 define hook-step
8702 mon cortex_m maskisr on
8703 end
8704 define hookpost-step
8705 mon cortex_m maskisr off
8706 end
8707 @end example
8708
8709 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
8710 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
8711 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
8712 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
8713
8714 @section Programming using GDB
8715 @cindex Programming using GDB
8716 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
8717
8718 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
8719 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
8720 @example
8721 gdb_memory_map disable
8722 @end example
8723 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
8724 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
8725 working area.
8726
8727 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
8728 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
8729 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
8730 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
8731
8732 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
8733 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
8734
8735 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
8736 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
8737 @example
8738 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
8739 @end example
8740
8741 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
8742 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
8743
8744 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
8745 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
8746 will be used.
8747
8748 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, an event
8749 script can be executed:
8750 @example
8751 $_TARGETNAME configure -event EVENTNAME BODY
8752 @end example
8753
8754 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
8755 can be used.
8756 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
8757 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
8758 @cindex SMP
8759 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
8760 @itemize @bullet
8761 @item j - smp status request
8762 @item J - smp set request
8763 @end itemize
8764
8765 OpenOCD implements :
8766 @itemize @bullet
8767 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
8768 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
8769 @option{E01} for target not smp.
8770 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
8771 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
8772 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
8773 @end itemize
8774
8775 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
8776 @itemize @bullet
8777 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
8778 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
8779 @example
8780 set $_core 1
8781 #Jc01 packet is sent
8782 print $_core
8783 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
8784 @end example
8785
8786 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
8787 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
8788
8789 @example
8790 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
8791 define toggle0
8792 maint packet Jc0
8793 continue
8794 main packet Jc-1
8795 end
8796 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
8797 define toggle1
8798 maint packet Jc1
8799 continue
8800 main packet Jc-1
8801 end
8802 @end example
8803 @end itemize
8804
8805 @section RTOS Support
8806 @cindex RTOS Support
8807 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
8808
8809 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
8810 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
8811
8812 @* An example setup is below:
8813
8814 @example
8815 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
8816 @end example
8817
8818 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
8819
8820 Currently supported rtos's include:
8821 @itemize @bullet
8822 @item @option{eCos}
8823 @item @option{ThreadX}
8824 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
8825 @item @option{linux}
8826 @item @option{ChibiOS}
8827 @item @option{embKernel}
8828 @item @option{mqx}
8829 @end itemize
8830
8831 @quotation Note
8832 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
8833 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
8834 @end quotation
8835
8836 @table @code
8837 @item eCos symbols
8838 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
8839 @item ThreadX symbols
8840 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
8841 @item FreeRTOS symbols
8842 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
8843 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
8844 @tex
8845 \begingroup
8846 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
8847 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
8848 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
8849 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
8850 \par
8851 \endgroup
8852 @end tex
8853 @item linux symbols
8854 init_task.
8855 @item ChibiOS symbols
8856 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
8857 @item embKernel symbols
8858 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
8859 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
8860 @item mqx symbols
8861 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
8862 @end table
8863
8864 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
8865 some, eg. FreeRTOS, extra steps must be taken.
8866
8867 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
8868 along with the project:
8869
8870 @table @code
8871 @item FreeRTOS
8872 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
8873 @end table
8874
8875 @node Tcl Scripting API
8876 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
8877 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
8878 @cindex Tcl scripts
8879 @section API rules
8880
8881 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
8882 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
8883 of state information as an argument to each proc.
8884
8885 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
8886 pair list and lists.
8887
8888 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
8889 list.
8890
8891 @example
8892 > set foo(me) Duane
8893 > set foo(you) Oyvind
8894 > set foo(mouse) Micky
8895 > set foo(duck) Donald
8896 @end example
8897
8898 If one does this:
8899
8900 @example
8901 > set foo
8902 @end example
8903
8904 The result is:
8905
8906 @example
8907 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
8908 @end example
8909
8910 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
8911
8912 @verbatim
8913 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
8914 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
8915 }
8916 @end verbatim
8917
8918 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
8919 should be passed in to the proc in question.
8920
8921 @section Internal low-level Commands
8922
8923 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
8924 invoke directly.
8925
8926 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
8927 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
8928 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
8929
8930 @itemize @bullet
8931 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8932
8933 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
8934 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
8935
8936 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
8937 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
8938
8939 Return information about the flash banks
8940
8941 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
8942
8943 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
8944 its execution. Example:
8945
8946 @example
8947 > capture "reset init"
8948 @end example
8949
8950 @end itemize
8951
8952 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
8953 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
8954 called "flash_banks".
8955
8956 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
8957
8958 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
8959 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
8960 holds one of the following values:
8961
8962 @itemize @bullet
8963 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
8964 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating sytem.
8965 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
8966 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
8967 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
8968 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating sytem
8969 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
8970 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
8971 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
8972 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
8973 @end itemize
8974
8975 Note: 'winxx' was choosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
8976
8977 @quotation Note
8978 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
8979 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
8980 @code{jim_platform} (because it
8981 is jim, not real tcl).
8982 @end quotation
8983
8984 @section Tcl RPC server
8985 @cindex RPC
8986
8987 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
8988 commands and receive the results.
8989
8990 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
8991 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
8992 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
8993 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
8994 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
8995
8996 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
8997 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
8998 @command{capture} command.
8999
9000 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
9001
9002 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
9003 @cindex RPC Notifications
9004
9005 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9006 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9007
9008 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
9009 in the following format.
9010
9011 @verbatim
9012 type target_event event [event-name]
9013 type target_state state [state-name]
9014 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
9015 @end verbatim
9016
9017 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
9018 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
9019 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9020 Defaults to off.
9021
9022 @end deffn
9023
9024 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
9025 @cindex RPC trace output
9026
9027 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
9028 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
9029
9030 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
9031
9032 @verbatim
9033 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
9034 @end verbatim
9035
9036 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
9037 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
9038 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
9039 Defaults to off.
9040
9041 See an example application here:
9042 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
9043
9044 @end deffn
9045
9046 @node FAQ
9047 @chapter FAQ
9048 @cindex faq
9049 @enumerate
9050 @anchor{faqrtck}
9051 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
9052 @cindex RTCK
9053 @cindex adaptive clocking
9054 @*
9055
9056 In digital circuit design it is often refered to as ``clock
9057 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
9058 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
9059 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
9060
9061 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
9062 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
9063 for example. There are 2 basic options:
9064 @enumerate
9065 @item
9066 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
9067 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
9068 @item
9069 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
9070 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
9071 @end enumerate
9072
9073 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
9074 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
9075 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
9076 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
9077 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
9078 power).
9079
9080 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
9081 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
9082 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
9083 ARM926 scenario).
9084 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
9085 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
9086 JTAG can use a faster clock.
9087
9088 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
9089 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
9090 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
9091 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
9092
9093 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
9094
9095 In order to make use of this,
9096 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
9097 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
9098
9099 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
9100 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
9101 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
9102 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
9103 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
9104
9105 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
9106 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
9107 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
9108 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
9109
9110 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
9111 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
9112 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
9113 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
9114 with a CPLD.
9115 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
9116 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
9117 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
9118 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
9119 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
9120 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
9121
9122 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
9123
9124 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
9125
9126 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
9127 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
9128 depending on the chips on your board.
9129 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
9130 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
9131 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
9132
9133 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
9134 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
9135 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
9136
9137 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
9138 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
9139 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
9140 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
9141
9142 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
9143 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
9144 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
9145 this way.
9146
9147 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
9148 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
9149 clock rate.
9150 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
9151 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
9152 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
9153
9154 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
9155
9156 @example
9157 # Example: 1.234MHz
9158 adapter_khz 1234
9159 @end example
9160
9161
9162 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
9163
9164 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
9165 around Windows filenames.
9166
9167 @example
9168 > echo \a
9169
9170 > echo @{\a@}
9171 \a
9172 > echo "\a"
9173
9174 >
9175 @end example
9176
9177
9178 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
9179
9180 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
9181 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
9182 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
9183
9184 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a frontend like Insight or
9185 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
9186 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
9187
9188 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
9189 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
9190 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
9191
9192 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
9193
9194 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
9195 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
9196 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
9197 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
9198
9199 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
9200 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
9201 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
9202
9203 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
9204 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
9205
9206 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
9207 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
9208 memory read caused data abort".
9209
9210 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
9211 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
9212 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
9213 be done, feel free to add this here.
9214
9215 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
9216 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
9217 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
9218 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
9219 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
9220 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
9221 gracefully stops.
9222
9223 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
9224 your C code, do the same - artifically push some zeros onto the stack,
9225 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
9226
9227 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
9228 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
9229 bytes. Painful...
9230
9231
9232 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
9233 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
9234
9235 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
9236 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
9237 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
9238 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
9239 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
9240 reset, everything else should work fine.
9241
9242 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
9243 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
9244 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
9245 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
9246
9247 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
9248 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
9249 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
9250 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
9251
9252 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
9253
9254 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
9255 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
9256 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
9257
9258 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
9259 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
9260
9261 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
9262 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
9263 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
9264 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
9265 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
9266 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
9267 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
9268 clock frequency?
9269
9270 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
9271 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
9272 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
9273 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
9274 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
9275
9276 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
9277
9278 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
9279 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
9280 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
9281 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
9282 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
9283 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
9284 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
9285
9286 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
9287
9288 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
9289 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
9290 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
9291 up DRAM and loading it with code.
9292
9293 @anchor{faqtaporder}
9294 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
9295 particular order?
9296
9297 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
9298 the same order used by the hardware.
9299
9300 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example: ST
9301 Microsystems STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
9302 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
9303 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
9304 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
9305 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
9306
9307 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
9308 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
9309 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
9310 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
9311
9312 @itemize @bullet
9313 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
9314 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
9315 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
9316 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
9317 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
9318 @end itemize
9319
9320 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
9321
9322 @itemize @bullet
9323 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
9324 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
9325 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
9326 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
9327 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
9328 @end itemize
9329
9330
9331 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
9332 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
9333 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
9334
9335 TODO.
9336
9337 @end enumerate
9338
9339 @node Tcl Crash Course
9340 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
9341 @cindex Tcl
9342
9343 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
9344 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
9345 how the Tcl scripts work.
9346
9347 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
9348 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
9349 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
9350 OpenOCD.
9351
9352 @section Tcl Rule #1
9353 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
9354 @enumerate
9355 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
9356 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9357 @end enumerate
9358
9359 The Tcl equal is this:
9360
9361 @enumerate
9362 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
9363 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9364 @end enumerate
9365
9366 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
9367 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
9368
9369 @section Tcl Rule #1b
9370 There is a second pair of rules.
9371 @enumerate
9372 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
9373 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
9374 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
9375 in Tcl.
9376 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
9377 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
9378 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
9379 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
9380 @end enumerate
9381
9382 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
9383 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
9384 deliberatly. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
9385 Everything is a string}
9386
9387 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
9388 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
9389 difference is subtle.
9390 @enumerate
9391 @item Parse Time
9392 @item Evaluation Time
9393 @end enumerate
9394
9395 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
9396 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
9397 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
9398
9399 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
9400 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
9401 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC langauge ``let x
9402 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
9403
9404 @itemize @bullet
9405 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
9406 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
9407 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
9408 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
9409 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
9410 @example
9411 # bash example
9412 X=`date`
9413 echo "The Date is: $X"
9414 # Tcl example
9415 set X [date]
9416 puts "The Date is: $X"
9417 @end example
9418 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
9419 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
9420 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
9421 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
9422 is a string}
9423 @example
9424 set x "Dinner"
9425 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
9426 @end example
9427 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
9428 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
9429 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
9430 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
9431 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
9432 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
9433 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
9434 @end itemize
9435
9436 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
9437
9438 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
9439
9440 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
9441
9442 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
9443 the normal way.
9444
9445 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
9446 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
9447 line is immedatly executed.
9448
9449 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
9450 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
9451
9452 @subsection Command Execution
9453
9454 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
9455 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
9456 control flow operators.
9457
9458 Commands are executed like this:
9459
9460 @enumerate
9461 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
9462 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
9463 @item Repeat until End Of File.
9464 @end enumerate
9465
9466 It sort of works like this:
9467 @example
9468 for(;;)@{
9469 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
9470
9471 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
9472
9473 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
9474 @}
9475 @end example
9476
9477 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
9478 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
9479 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
9480 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
9481 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
9482 ``LookupCommand()''
9483
9484 @subsection The FOR command
9485
9486 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
9487 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
9488 command just like any other command.
9489
9490 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
9491 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
9492 are:
9493
9494 @enumerate 0
9495 @item The ascii text 'for'
9496 @item The start text
9497 @item The test expression
9498 @item The next text
9499 @item The body text
9500 @end enumerate
9501
9502 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
9503 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
9504 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
9505 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
9506
9507 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
9508 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
9509
9510 @example
9511 int
9512 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
9513 int *argc,
9514 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
9515 @end example
9516
9517 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
9518 introduced a byte-code parser and intepreter, but at the core, it
9519 still operates in the same basic way.
9520
9521 @subsection FOR command implementation
9522
9523 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
9524 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
9525
9526 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
9527
9528 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
9529
9530 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
9531 string. Commands can be seperated by semicolons, or newlines. While
9532 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
9533
9534 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
9535 expression and returns a value.
9536
9537 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
9538 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
9539 @example
9540 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
9541
9542 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
9543
9544 int
9545 MyForCommand( void *interp,
9546 int argc,
9547 char **argv )
9548 @{
9549 if( argc != 5 )@{
9550 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
9551 return ERROR;
9552 @}
9553
9554 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
9555
9556 // Execute the start statement.
9557 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
9558
9559 // Top of loop test
9560 for(;;)@{
9561 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
9562 if( i == 0 )
9563 break;
9564
9565 // Execute the body
9566 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
9567
9568 // Execute the LOOP part
9569 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
9570 @}
9571
9572 // Return no error
9573 SetResult( interp, "" );
9574 return SUCCESS;
9575 @}
9576 @end example
9577
9578 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
9579 in the same basic way.
9580
9581 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
9582
9583 @subsection source and find commands
9584 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
9585 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
9586 @*Remember the parsing rules
9587 @enumerate
9588 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
9589 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
9590 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
9591 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
9592 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
9593 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
9594 That character begins Tcl comments.)
9595 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
9596 it reads a file and executes as a script.
9597 @end enumerate
9598 @subsection format command
9599 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
9600 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
9601 @b{sprintf()}.
9602 @b{Example}
9603 @example
9604 set x 6
9605 set y 7
9606 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
9607 @end example
9608 @enumerate
9609 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
9610 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
9611 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
9612 @* Refer to Rule #1
9613 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
9614 @* Refer to Rule #1.
9615 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
9616 @end enumerate
9617 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
9618 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
9619 @example
9620 #1 Good
9621 proc someproc @{@} @{
9622 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
9623 @}
9624 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
9625 #2 Good - no variables
9626 $_TARGETNAME confgure -event foo "this ; that;"
9627 #3 Good Curly Braces
9628 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
9629 puts "Time: [date]"
9630 @}
9631 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
9632 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
9633 @end example
9634 @enumerate
9635 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
9636 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
9637 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
9638 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
9639 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
9640 command.
9641 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
9642 @*There are 4 examples:
9643 @enumerate
9644 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
9645 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands seperated by semicolons
9646 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
9647 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
9648 @end enumerate
9649
9650 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
9651 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
9652 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
9653
9654 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
9655 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
9656 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
9657 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
9658 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
9659 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
9660 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
9661 @end enumerate
9662 @subsection Global Variables
9663 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
9664 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
9665 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
9666 @example
9667 proc myproc @{ @} @{
9668 set y 0 #Local variable Y
9669 global x #Global variable X
9670 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
9671 @}
9672 @end example
9673 @section Other Tcl Hacks
9674 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
9675 @example
9676 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
9677 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
9678 # Create var name
9679 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
9680 # Make it a global
9681 global $vn
9682 # Set it.
9683 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
9684 @}
9685 @end example
9686 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
9687 @example
9688 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
9689 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
9690 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
9691 @}
9692 @end example
9693
9694 @include fdl.texi
9695
9696 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
9697 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
9698 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
9699 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
9700 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
9701 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
9702
9703 @printindex cp
9704
9705 @node Command and Driver Index
9706 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
9707 @printindex fn
9708
9709 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)